Wa320 3 PDF
Wa320 3 PDF
Wa320 3 PDF
Shop
Manual
WA32~=3
WHEEL LOADER
It is our policy to improve our products whenever it is possible and practical to do so. We reserve the right to make
changes or add improvements at any time without incurring any obligation to install such changes on products sold
previously.
Due to this continuous program of research and development, periodic revisions may be made to this publication.
It is recommended that customers contact their distributor for information on the latest revision.
00-2
PRODUCT PUBLICATIONS INFORMATION
VARIOUS PRODUCT PARTS & SERVICE PUBLICATIONS ARE AVAILABLE TO ALL KOMATSU CONSTRUCTION
EQUIPMENT OWNERS, INCLUDING OPERATION & MAINTENANCE MANUALS, PARTS BOOKS AND SHOP
MANUALS.
SPECIAL PUBLICATIONS SUCH AS SERVICE TOOL, AIR CONDITIONING, AND TURBOCHARGER SHOP
MANUALS ARE ALSO AVAILABLE AS WELL AS SELECTED OPERATION & MAINTENANCE AND SHOP
MANUALS IN FOREIGN LANGUAGES.
THE PUBLICATIONS LISTED BELOW ARE AVAILABLE FOR THIS PARTICULAR MACHINE(S).
SHOP MANUAL:
SAFETYMANUAL....................................................... WLT70-1
IF THE PIPS SYSTEM IS NOT AVAILABLE AT THE DISTRIBUTOR LOCATION, THEN THE FOLLOWING
REQUISITION FOR TECHNICAL SERVICE PUBLICATIONS AND SERVICE FORMS CAN BE USED. FORM
KDCSID IS SHOWN ON THE REVERSE SIDE OF THIS PAGE.
REQUISITION FOR TECHNICAL SERVICE PUBLICATIONS AND SERVICE FORMS
COMPLETE FORM
AND RETURN TO - Komatsu America International Company
440 North Fairway Drive
Vernon Hills, IL 60061-8112 U.S.A.
Attn: Technical Publications
Fax No. (847) 970-4186
Tel No. (847) 970-5887
COMPANY NAME
SHIP TO l
AlTN.
STREET ADDRESS
TYPE or PRINT
CITY, STATE, ZIP CODE
ONLY .
COUNTRY I
IMPORTANT -TO ASSURE SHIPMENT OF THE CORRECT PUBLICATION(S), THE MODEL NUMBER AND MACHINE
SERIAL NUMBER MUST BE SHOWN.
PARTS BOOK
PUBLICATION
PUBLICATION FORM NO. SERIAL NUMBER
$ M_;;;;;he DESCRIPTION MoDEL NUMBER
UARK PAGE REV MARK PAGE REV MARK PAGE REV VlARK PAGE REV
'JARK PAGE REV MARK PAGE REV MARK PAGE REV MARK PAGE REV
00-2-2
0
LIST OF ORIGINAL, NEW AND REVISED PAGES
MARK PAGE REV VlARK PAGE REV 'JlARK PAGE REV MARK PAGE REV
0 20-359 0 20-421 0 30-I 0 30-56
0 20-360 0 20-422 0 30-2 0 30-57
0 20-361 0 20-423 0 30-3 0 30-58
0 20-362 0 20-424 0 30-4 0 30-59
0 20-363 0 20-425 0 30-5 0 30-60
0 20-364 0 20-426 0 30-6 0 30-61
0 20-365 0 20-427 0 30-7 0 30-62
0 20-366 0 20-428 0 30-8 0 30-63
0 20-367 0 20-429 0 30-9 0 30-64
0 20-368 0 20-430 0 30-10 0 30-65
0 20-369 0 20-431 0 30-11 0 30-66
0 20-370 0 20-432 0 30-12 0 30-67
0 20-371 0 20-433 0 30-68
0 20-372 0 20-434 0 0 30-69
0 20-373 0 20-435 0 30-15 0 30-70
0 20-374 0 20-436 0 0 30-71
0 20-375 0 20-437 0 30-17 0 30-72
0 20-376 0 20-438 0 30-18 0 30-73
0 20-377 0 20-439 0 30-19 0 30-74
0 20-378 0 20-440 0 30-20 0 30-75
0 20-379 0 20-441 0 30-21 0 30-76
0 20-380 0 20-442 0 30-22 0 30-77
0 20-381 0 20-443 0 30-23 0 30-78
0 20-382 0 20-444 0 30-24 0 30-79
0 20-383 0 20-445 0 30-25 0 30-80
0 20-384 0 20-446 0 30-26 0 30-81
0 20-385 0 20-447 0 30-27 0 30-82
0 20-386 0 20-448 0 30-28 0 30-83
0 20-387 0 20-449 0 30-29 0 30-84
0 20-388 0 20-450 0 30-30 0 30-85
0 20-389 0 20-451 0 30-31 0 30-86
0 20-390 0 20-452 0 30-32 0 30-87
0 20-391 0 20-453 0 30-33 0 30-88
0 20-392 0 20-454 0 30-34 0 30-89
0 20-455 0 30-35 0 30-90
0 20-401 0 20-456 0 30-36 0 30-91
0 20-402 0 20-457 0 30-37 0 30-92
0 20-403 0 20-458 0 30-38 0 30-93
0 20-404 0 20-459 0 30-39 0 30-94
0 20-405 0 20-460 0 30-40 0 30-95
0 20-406 0 20-461 0 30-41 0 30-96
0 20-407 0 20-462 0 30-42 0 30-97
0 20-408 0 20-463 0 30-43 0 30-98
0 20-409 0 20-464 0 30-44 0 30-99
0 20-410 0 30-45 0 30-100
0 20-411 0 20-701 0 30-46 0 30-101
0 20-412 0 20-702 0 30-47 0 30-102
0 20-413 0 20-703 0 30-48 0 30-103
0 20-414 0 20-704 0 30-49 0 30-104
0 20-415 0 30-50 0 30-105
0 20-416 0 30-51 0 30-106
0 20-417 0 30-52 0 30-107
0 20-418 0 30-53 0 30-108
0 20-419 0 30-54 0 30-109
0 20-420 0 30-55 0 30-110
00-2-3
0
LIST OF ORIGINAL, NEW AND REVISED PAGES
MARK PAGE REV MARK PAGE REV MARK PAGE REV MARK PAGE REV
0 30-111 0 30-166 40-26
0 30-112 0 30-167 40-27
0 30-113 0 30-168 40-28
0 30-114 0 30-169 40-29
0 30-115 0 30-170 40-30
0 30-116 0 30-171 40-31
0 30-117 0 30-172 40-32
0 30-118 0 30-173 40-33
0 30-119 0 30-174 40-34
0 30-120 0 30-175 40-35
0 30-121 0 30-176 40-36
0 30-122 0 30-177 40-37
0 30-123 0 30-178 40-38
0 30-124 0 30-179 40-39
0 30-125 0 30-180 40-40
0 30-126 0 30-181 40-41
0 30-127 0 30-182 40-42
0 30-128 0 30-183 40-43
0 30-129 0 30-184 40-44
0 30-130 0 30-185 40-45
0 30-131 0 30-186 40-46
0 30-132 0 30-187 40-47
0 30-133 0 30-188 40-48
0 30-134 0 30-189 40-49
0 30-135 0 30-190 40-50
0 30-136 0 30-191
0 30-137 0 30-192
0 30-138
0 30-139
0 30-140
40-I
0 30-141
0 40-2
0 30-142
40-3
0 30-143
40-4
0 30-144
40-5
0 30-145
40-6
0 30-146
40-7
0 30-147
40-8
0 30-148
40-9
0 30-149
40-10
0 30-150
40-11
0 30-151
40-12
0 30-152
40-13
0 30-153
40-14
0 30-154
40-15
0 30-155
40-16
0 30-156
40-17
0 30-157
40-18
0 30-158
40-19
0 30-159
l 40-20
0 30-160
40-21
0 30-161
40-22
0 30-162
40-23
0 30-163
40-24
0 30-164
40-25
0 30-165
00-2-4
0
SAFETY SAFETY NOTICE
SAFETY
SAFETY NOTICE
Proper service and repair is extremely important for the safe operation of your machine. The service and
repair techniques recommended and described in this manual are both effective and safe methods of
operation. Some of these operations require the use of tools specially designed for the purpose.
To prevent injury to workers, the symbols A and *q are used to mark safety precautions in this manual. The
cautions accompanying these symbols should always be followed carefully. If any dangerous situation arises
or may possibly arise, first consider safety, and take the necessary actions to deal with the situation.
GENERAL PRECAUTIONS and removed parts. Always keep the tools and parts
in their correct places. Always keep the work area
Mistakes in operation are extremely dangerous. Read clean and make sure that there is no dirt or oil on the
the OPERATION & MAINTENANCE MANUAL carefully floor. Smoke only in the areas provided for smoking.
BEFORE operating the machine. Never smoke while working.
1. Before carrying out any greasing or repairs, read all PREPARATIONS FOR WORK
the precautions given on the decals which are fixed
to the machine. 7. Before adding oil or making repairs, park the
machine on hard, level ground, and block the wheels
2. When carrying out any operation, always wear safety or tracks to prevent the machine from moving.
shoes and helmet. Do not wear loose work clothes,
or clothes with buttons missing. 8. Before starting work, lower blade, ripper, bucket or
any other work equipment to the ground. If this is not
l Always wear safety glasses when hitting parts with
possible, insert the safety pin or use blocks to
a hammer.
prevent the work equipment from falling. In addition,
l Always wear safety glasses when grinding parts be sure to lock all the control levers and hang
with a grinder, etc. warning signs on them.
3. If welding repairs are needed, always have a trained, 9. When disassembling or assembling, support the
experienced welder carry out the work. When machine with blocks, jacks or stands before starting
carrying out welding work, always wear welding work.
gloves, apron, glasses, cap and other clothes suited
for welding work. 10. Remove all mud and oil from the steps or other
places used to get on and off the machine. Always
4. When carrying out any operation with two or more use the handrails, ladders or steps when getting on
workers, always agree on the operating procedure or off the machine. Never jump on or off the
before starting. Always inform your fellow workers machine. If it is impossible to use the handrails,
before starting any step of the operation. Before ladders or steps, use a stand to provide safe footing.
starting work, hang UNDER REPAIR signs on the
controls in the operator’s compartment. PRECAUTIONS DURING WORK
5. Keep all tools in good condition and learn the correct 11. When removing the oil filler cap, drain plug or
way to use them. hydraulic pressure measuring plugs, loosen them
slowly to prevent the oil from spurting out. Before
6. Decide a place in the repair workshop to keep tools disconnecting or removing components of the oil,
00-3
SAFETY SAFETY NOTICE
water or air circuits, first remove the pressure completely 18. As a general rule, do not use gasoline to wash parts.
from the circuit. In particular, use only the minimum of gasoline when
washing electrical parts.
12. The water and oil in the circuits are hot when the
engine is stopped, so be careful not to get burned. 19. Be sure to assemble all parts again in their original
Wait for the oil and water to cool before carrying out places. Replace any damaged part with new parts.
any work on the oil or water circuits.
l When installing hoses and wires, be sure that
they will not be damaged by contact with other
13. Before starting work, remove the leads from the
parts when the machine is being operated.
battery. ALWAYS remove the lead from the negative
(-) terminal first.
20. When installing high pressure hoses, make sure that
they are not twisted. Damaged tubes are dangerous,
14. When raising heavy components, use a hoist or
so be extremely careful when installing tubes for
crane. Check that the wire rope, chains and hooks
high pressure circuits. Also check that connecting
are free from damage. Always use lifting equipment
parts are correctly installed.
which has ample capacity. Install the lifting
equipment at the correct places. Use a hoist or crane
21. When assembling or installing parts, always use the
and operate slowly to prevent the component from
specified tightening torques. When installing
hitting any other part. Do not work with any part still
protective parts such as guards, or parts which
raised by the hoist or crane.
vibrate violently or rotate at high speed, be partic-
ularly careful to check that they are installed
15. When removing covers which are under internal
correctly.
pressure or under pressure from a spring, always
leave two bolts in position on opposite sides. Slowly
22. When aligning two holes, never insert your fingers or
release the pressure, then slowly loosen the bolts to
hand. Be careful not to get your fingers caught in a
remove.
hole.
00-4
FOREWARD GENERAL
FOREWARD
GENERAL
This shop manual has been prepared as an aid to improve the quality of repairs by giving the serviceman an accurate
understanding of the product and by showing him the correct way to perform repairs and make judgements. Make sure
you understand the contents of this manual and use it to full effect at every opportunity.
This shop manual mainly contains the necessary technical information for operations performed in a service workshop.
For ease of understanding, the manual is divided into the following sections. These sections are further divided into
each main group of components.
GENERAL
This section lists the general machine dimensions, performance specifications, component weights, and fuel,
coolant and lubricant specification charts.
This section explains the structure and function of each component. It serves not only to give an understanding
of the structure, but also serves as reference material for troubleshooting.
This section explains checks to be made before and after performing repairs, as well as adjustments to be made
at completion of the checks and repairs. Troubleshooting charts correlating “Problems” to “Causes” are also
included in this section.
This section explains the order to be followed when removing, installing, disassembling or assembling each
component, as well as precautions to be taken for these operations.
MAINTENANCE STANDARD
This section gives the judgement standards when inspecting disassembled parts.
NOTICE
The specifications contained in this shop manual are subject to change at any time and without any advance
notice. Contact your distributor for the latest information.
I I
00-5
FOREWARD HOW TO READ THE SHOP MANUAL
Shop manuals are issued as a guide to carrying out When a manual is revised, an edition mark (@I@@ ....) is
repairs. They are divided as follows: recorded on the bottom outside corner of the pages.
Chassis volume: Issued for every machine model
Engine volume: Issued for each engine series REVISIONS
Electrical volume: Each issued as one to cover all
models Revised pages are shown at the LIST OF REVISED
Attachment volume: Each issued as one to cover all PAGES between the title page and SAFETY page.
models
SYMBOLS
These various volumes are designed to avoid duplication
of information. Therefore to deal with all repairs for any So that the shop manual can be of ample practical use,
model, it is necessary that chassis, engine electrical and important places for safety and quality are marked with
attachment be available. the following symbols.
Any additions, amendments or other changes will be sent Special safety precautions are
to your distributors. Get the most up-to-date
before you start any work.
information
A I
Safety necessary when performing the
work.
fk
Coat
Consecutive page number for adhesives and lubricants etc.
each item Places where oil, water or fuel
Oil, water
I& must be added, and the capacity.
Example 2 (Engine volume):
Refer to the pertinent engine manual. Places where oil or water must be
Drain drained, and quantity to be
drained.
3. Additional pages: Additional pages are indicated by
a hyphen (-) and numbered after the page number.
File as in the example.
Example:
IO-4
1o-4-1
Added pages
1o-4-2
1o-5
00-6
FOREWARD HOISTING INSTRUCTIONS
HOISTING INSTRUCTIONS
HOISTING
EGO064
A
to the relative parts. Slinging with one rope may cause turning of
2) Check for existence of another part causing the load during hoisting, untwisting of the
interface with the part to be removed. rope, or slipping of the rope from its original winding
position on the load, which can result in a dangerous
WIRE ROPES accident.
1) Use adequate ropes depending on the weight of
parts to be hoisted, referring to the table below:
4) Do not sling a heavy load with ropes forming a
wide hanging angle from the hook. When hoisting
wire ropes
a load with two or more ropes, the force subjected
(Standard “Z” or “S” twist ropes without galvanizing
to each rope will increase with the hanging angles.
Rope diameter (mm) 1 Allowable load (tons) The table below shows the variation of allowable
load (kg) when hoisting is made with two ropes,
10.0 1.0 each of which is allowed to sling up to 1000 kg
11.2 1.4 vertically, at various hanging angles. When two
12.5 1.6 ropes sling a load vertically, up to 2000 kg of total
14.0 2.2 weight can be suspended. This weight becomes
16.0 2.8 1000 kg when two ropes make a 120” hanging
18.0 3.6 angle. On the other hand, two ropes are subject to
20.0 4.4 an excessive force as large as 4000 kg if they
22.4 5.6 sling a 2000 kg load at a lifting angle of 150”.
30.0 10.0
40.0 18.0
50.0 28.0
60.0 40.0
*
The allowable load value is estimated to be l/6 or
l/7 of the breaking strength of the rope used.
00-7
FOREWARD COATING MATERIALS
COATING MATERIALS
The recommended coating materials prescribed in the shop manuals are listed below.
00-8
FOREWARD STANDARD TORQUE REQUIREMENTS
The following charts give the standard torques values of bolts and nuts. Exceptions are given in sections of
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY.
1 kgm = 9.806 Nm
* This torque table does not apply to the bolts with which nylon packing or other non-ferrous metal washers are
to be used, or which require torquing to otherwise specified values.
00-9
FOREWARD STANDARD TORQUE REQUIREMENTS
mm mm I kw I Nm
mm mm kgm Nm
00-l0
FOREWARD ELECTRIC WIRE CODE
In the wiring diagrams, various colors and symbols are employed to indicate the thickness of wires. This wire code
table will help you understand WIRING DIAGRAMS.
Example: 05WB indicates a cable having a nominal number 05 and white coating with black stripe.
CLASSIFICATION BY THICKNESS
Copper wire I 1 I
Nominal
Applicable circuit
number ~10.C,a~Ern) Curre$rating
Priority Classification Circuits Charging Ground Starting Lighting Instruments Signal Other
Code W B B R Y G L
1 Primary
Color White Black Black Red Yellow Green Blue
Code WR - BW RW YR GW LW
2
I Color 1 White/Red 1 - 1 BlackNvhite 1 Red/White I Yellow/Red I GreenMmite I Blue/White
Code WB - BY RB YB GR LR
3
Color White/Black - BlackM?llow Red/Black Yellow/Black Green/Red Blue/Red
Code WL - BR RY YG GY LY
4 Auxiliary
Color White/Blue - Black/Red RedNellow Yellow/Green GreemYellow BlueNellow
Code WG - - RG YL GB LB
5
I Color I White/Green I - I - I Red/Green I Yellow/Blue I G~WBIX~ I Blue/Black
Code - - - RL YW GL -
6
Color - - - Red/Blue YellowNVhite Green/Blue -
00-I 1
FOREWARD CONVERSION TABLES
CONVERSION TABLES
EXAMPLE
l Method of using the Conversion Table to convert from millimeters to inches.
1. Convert 55 mm into inches.
(1) Locate the number 50 in the vertical column at the left side, take this as 0, then draw a horizontal line from
0.
(2) Locate the number 5 in the row across the top, take this as 0, then draw a perpendicular line down from 0.
(3) Take the point where the two lines cross as 0. This point @ gives the value when converting from millimeters
to inches. Therefore, 55 millimeters = 2.165 inches.
Millimeters to Inches
1 mm = 0.03937 in
mm 0 1 2 3 4 5@ 6 7 8 9
00-I 2
FOREWARD CONVERSION TABLES
Millimeters to Inches
1 mm=O.O3937in
mm 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 0.394 0.433 0.472 0.512 0.551 0.591 0.630 0.669 0.709 0.748
20 0.787 0.827 0.866 0.906 0.945 0.984 1.024 1.063 1.102 1.142
30 1.181 1.220 1.260 1.299 1.339 1.378 1.417 1.457 1.496 1.536
40 1.575 1.614 1.654 1.693 1.732 1.772 1.811 1.850 1.890 1.929
50 1.969 2.008 2.047 2.087 2.126 2.165 2.205 2.244 2.283 2.323
60 2.362 2.402 2.441 2.480 2.520 2.559 2.598 2.638 2.677 2.717
70 2.756 2.795 2.835 2.874 2.913 2.953 2.992 3.032 3.071 3.110
80 3.150 3.189 3.228 3.268 3.307 3.346 3.386 3.425 3.465 3.504
90 3.543 3.583 3.622 3.661 3.701 3.740 3.780 3.819 3.858 3.898
Kilogram to Pound
1 kg = 2.2046 lb
kg 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
IO 22.05 24.25 26.46 28.66 30.86 33.07 35.27 37.48 39.68 41.89
20 44.09 46.30 48.50 50.71 51.91 55.12 57.32 59.53 61.73 63.93
30 66.14 68.34 70.55 72.75 74.96 77.16 79.37 81.57 83.78 85.98
40 88.18 90.39 92.59 94.80 97.00 99.21 101.41 103.62 105.82 108.03
50 110.23 112.44 114.64 116.85 119.05 121.25 123.46 125.66 127.87 130.07
60 132.28 134.48 136.69 138.89 141.10 143.30 145.51 147.71 149.91 152.12
70 154.32 156.53 158.73 160.94 163.14 165.35 167.55 169.76 171.96 174.17
80 176.37 178.57 180.78 182.98 185.19 187.39 189.60 191.80 194.01 196.21
90 198.42 200.62 202.83 205.03 207.24 209.44 211.64 213.85 216.05 218.26
00-I 3
FOREWARD CONVERSIONTABLES
P 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
IO 2.642 2.906 3.170 3.434 3.698 3.963 4.227 4.491 4.755 5.019
20 5.283 5.548 5.812 6.076 6.340 6.604 6.869 7.133 7.397 7.661
30 7.925 8.189 8.454 8.718 8.982 9.246 9.510 9.774 10.039 10.303
40 10.567 10.831 11.095 11.359 11.624 11.888 12.152 12.416 12.680 12.944
50 13.209 13.473 13.737 14.001 14.265 14.529 14.795 15.058 15.322 15.586
60 15.850 16.115 16.379 16.643 16.907 17.171 17.435 17.700 17.964 18.228
70 18.492 18.756 19.020 19.285 19.549 19.813 20.077 20.341 20.605 20.870
80 21.134 21.398 21.662 21.926 22.190 22.455 22.719 22.983 23.247 23.511
90 23.775 24.040 24.304 24.568 24.832 25.096 25.361 25.625 25.889 26.153
LitertoU.K. Gallon
14 = 0.21997 U.K. Gal
P 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 2.200 2.420 2.640 2.860 3.080 3.300 3.520 3.740 3.950 4.179
20 4.399 4.619 4.839 5.059 5.279 5.499 5.719 5.939 6.159 6.379
30 6.599 6.819 7.039 7.259 7.479 7.699 7.919 8.139 8.359 8.579
40 8.799 9.019 9.239 9.459 9.679 9.899 10.119 10.339 10.559 10.778
50 10.998 11.281 11.438 11.658 11.878 12.098 12.318 12.528 12.758 12.978
60 13.198 13.418 13.638 13.858 14.078 14.298 14.518 14.738 14.958 15.178
70 15.398 15.618 15.838 16.058 16.278 16.498 16.718 16.938 17.158 17.378
80 17.598 17.818 18.037 18.257 18.477 18.697 18.917 19.137 19.357 19.577
90 19.797 20.017 20.237 20.457 20.677 20.897 21.117 21.337 21.557 21.777
00-14
FOREWARD CONVERSION TABLES
kgm to ft. lb
1 kam = 7.233 ft.lb
kgm 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
I 8 9
10 72.3 79.6 86.8 94.0 101.3 108.5 115.7 123.0 130.2 137.4
20 144.7 151.9 159.1 166.4 173.6 180.8 188.1 195.3 282.5 209.8
30 217.0 224.2 231.5 238.7 245.9 253.2 260.4 267.6 274.9 282.1
40 289.3 296.6 303.8 311.0 318.3 325.5 332.7 340.0 347.2 354.4
50 361.7 368.9 376.1 383.4 390.6 397.8 405.1 412.3 419.5 426.8
60 434.0 441.2 448.5 455.7 462.9 470.2 477.4 484.6 491.8 499.1
70 506.3 513.5 520.8 528.0 535.2 542.5 549.7 556.9 564.2 571.4
80 578.6 585.9 593.1 600.3 607.6 614.8 622.0 629.3 636.5 643.7
90 651.0 658.2 665.4 672.7 679.9 687.1 694.4 701.6 708.8 716.1
100 723.3 730.5 737.8 745.0 752.2 759.5 766.7 773.9 781.2 788.4
110 795.6 802.9 810.1 817.3 824.6 831.8 839.0 846.3 853.5 860.7
120 868.0 875.2 882.4 889.7 896.9 904.1 911.4 918.6 925.8 933.1
130 940.3 947.5 954.8 962.0 969.2 976.5 983.7 990.9 998.2 1005.4
140 1012.6 1019.9 1027.1 1034.3 1041.5 1048.8 1056.0 1063.2 1070.5 1077.7
150 1084.9 1092.2 1099.4 1106.6 1113.9 1121.1 1128.3 1135.6 1142.8 1150.0
160 1157.3 1164.5 1171.7 1179.0 1186.2 1193.4 1200.7 1207.9 1215.1 1222.4
170 1129.6 1236.8 1244.1 1251.3 1258.5 1265.8 1273.0 1280.1 1287.5 1294.7
180 1301.9 1309.2 1316.4 1323.6 1330.9 1338.1 1345.3 1352.6 1359.8 1367.0
190 1374.3 1381.5 1388.7 1396.0 1403.2 1410.4 1417.7 1424.9 1432.1 1439.4
00-l5
FOREWARD CONVERSIONTABLES
kg/cm2 to lb/W
Ik zm2 = 14.2233 lb/in2
kg/cm2 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 142.2 156.5 170.7 184.9 199.1 213.4 227.6 241.8 256.0 270.2
20 284.5 298.7 312.9 327.1 341.4 355.6 369.8 384.0 398.3 412.5
30 426.7 440.9 455.1 469.4 483.6 497.8 512.0 526.3 540.5 554.7
40 568.9 583.2 597.4 611.6 625.8 640.1 654.3 668.5 682.7 696.9
50 711.2 725.4 739.6 753.8 768.1 782.3 796.5 810.7 825.0 839.2
60 853.4 867.6 881.8 896.1 910.3 924.5 938.7 953.0 967.2 981.4
70 995.6 1010 1024 1038 1053 1067 1081 1095 1109 1124
80 1138 1152 1166 1181 1195 1209 1223 1237 1252 1266
90 1280 1294 1309 1323 1337 1351 1365 1380 1394 1408
100 1422 1437 1451 1465 1479 1493 1508 1522 1536 1550
110 1565 1579 1593 1607 1621 1636 1650 1664 1678 1693
120 1707 1721 1735 1749 1764 1778 1792 1806 1821 1835
130 1849 1863 1877 1892 1906 1920 1934 1949 1963 1977
140 1991 2005 2020 2034 2048 2062 2077 2091 2105 2119
150 2134 2148 2162 2176 2190 2205 2219 2233 2247 2262
160 2276 2290 2304 2318 2333 2347 2361 2375 2389 2404
170 2418 2432 2446 2460 2475 2489 2503 2518 2532 2546
180 2560 2574 2589 2603 2617 2631 2646 2660 2674 2688
190 2702 2717 2731 2745 2759 2773 2788 2802 2816 2830
200 2845 2859 2873 2887 2901 2916 2930 2944 2958 2973
210 2987 3001 3015 3030 3044 3058 3072 3086 3101 3115
220 3129 3143 3158 3172 3186 3200 3214 3229 3243 3257
230 3271 3286 3300 3314 3328 3343 3357 3371 3385 3399
240 3414 3428 3442 3456 3470 3485 3499 3513 3527 3542
00-16
FOREWARD CONVERSIONTABLES
Temperature
Fahrenheit Centigrade Conversion; a simple way to convert a Fahrenheit temperature reading into a Centigrade temperature reading or vise
versa is to enter the accompanying table in the center or boldface column of figures. These figures refer to the temperature in either Fahrenheit
or Centigrade degrees. If it is desired to convert from Fahrenheit to Centigrade degrees, consider the center column as a table of Fahrenheit
temperatures and read the corresponding Centigrade temperature in the column at the left. If it is desired to convert from Centigrade to
Fahrenheit degrees, consider the center column as a table of Centigrade values, and read the corresponding Fahrenheit temperature on the
right.
l°C=33.8"F
01-l
GENERAL SPECIFICATION DRAWINGS
SPECIFICATION DRAWINGS
WA320-3
01-2
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
SPECIFICATIONS
Grade-ability 25 deg
Wheelbase 3030 mm
Tread 2050 mm
:
‘65
c Minimum ground clearance 400 mm
.-E
n
Height of bucket hinge pin 3815 mm
01-3
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
01-4
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
(Hydraulic+Steering+Switch+PPC pump)
p Set pressure for work equipment Spool type 20.59 Mpa (210 kg/cm2)
P
T Set pressure for steering Orbit-roll valve type 20.59 Mpa 210 kg/cm2)
s
Boom cylinder qty. - bore x stroke Reciprocating piston 2-140 x 703
a
Iz
z Bucket cylinder
-.-
Steering cylinder
Linkage type
qty. - bore x stroke
Z-bar linkage
01-5
GENERAL WEIGHT TABLE
WEIGHT TABLE
kg kg
Engine 730 Main control valve 75
Transmission with torque converter 680 Engine hood with side panel I 165
Orbit-roll valve 8
01-6
GENERAL FUEL, COOLANT AND LUBRICANTS
Engine
oil
Axle (each)
(Front and rear) Axle oil See note 1 25Q 25Q
Diesel
Fuel tank 221 Q
fuel
*: NLGI No. 0
When operating a machine with the auto-greasing system at temperatures below -20% (-4OF), set the greasing time to 20
minutes. See the Operation & Maintenance Manual.
01-7
GENERAL ENGINE OIL SPECIFICATIONS
The use of a quality engine lubricating oil combined with Single graded oils may be used if multi-graded oil is not
appropriate oil and filter change intervals are critical factors available. But be sure to use oil that matches the
in maintaining engine performance and durability. temperature shown in the table.
SAE 15W-40 multi-viscosity oil meeting the American Special break-in lubricating oils are not recommended for a
Petroleum Institute (API) performance classification of CF-4 new or rebuilt engine. Use the same type of oil during the
is recommended. break-in as specified for normal operation.
* CD or CD/SF oils may be used in areas where CE or Additional information regarding lubricating oil availability
CF-4 oil is not yet available. throughout the world is available in the “E.M.A. Lubricating
Oils Data Book for Automotive and Industrial Engines”. The
A sulfated ash limit of 1.0 mass percent is suggested for data book may be ordered from the Engine Manufacturers
optimum valve and piston deposit and oil consumption Association, 401 North Michigan Ave., Chicago, II U.S.A.
control. the sulfated ash must not exceed 1.85 mass 60611. The telephone number is (312) 644-6610.
percent. The sulfated ash limit of 1.85 mass percent has
been placed on all engine lubricating oils recommended for Arctic Operation
use in the engine. Higher ash oils can cause valve and/or
piston damage and lead to excessive oil consumption. If an engine is operated in ambient temperatures
consistently below -23°C (-10°F) and there are no
The API service symbol displays the following information. provisions to keep the engine warm when it is not in
The upper half of the symbol displays the appropriate oil operation, use a synthetic API performance classification CE
categories; the lower half may contain words to describe oil or CF-4 engine oil with adequate low temperature properties
energy conserving features. The center section identifies the such as SAE 5W-20 or 5W-30.
SAE oil viscosity grade.
The oil supplier must be responsible for meeting the
Oil viscosity recommendations are as follows: performance service specifications.
The use of a multi-graded lubricating oil has been found to * T,he use of a synthetic base oil does not justify extended
improve oil consumption control and improve engine 011change intervals. Extended oil change intervals can
cranking in cold temperatures while maintaining lubrication decrease engine life due to factors such as; corrosion,
at high operating temperatures. deposits and wear.
01-8
GENERAL DIESEL FUEL SPECIFICATIONS
Where a winterized blend of Grade No. 2-D and No. 1-D fuels
* Due to the precise tolerances of diesel injection is available, it may be substituted for Grade No. I-D fuel.
systems, it is extremely important that the fuel be kept However, it is the suppliers responsibility to provide the fuel
clean and free of dirt or water. Dirt or water in the system can for the anticipated ambient temperature.
cause severe damage to both the injection pump and nozzles.
Use a low sulfur content fuel having a cloud point that is at
For normal service above -12°C (+lO”F), the use of ASTM least IO degrees below the lowest expected fuel temperature.
Grade No. 2-D diesel fuel with a minimum Cetane number of Cloud point is the temperature at which crystals begin to form
40 is recommended. The use of No. 2-D diesel fuel will result in the fuel. The viscosity of the fuel must be kept above 1.3
in optimum engine performance under most operating cSt to provide adequate fuel system lubrication.
conditions. Fuels with Cetane numbers higher than 40 may be
needed in high altitudes or extremely low ambient
temperatures to prevent misfires and excessive smoke.
01-9
GENERAL COOLANT SPECIFICATIONS
COOLANT SPECIFICATIONS
GENERAL ANTIFREEZE
Selection and maintenance of the engine coolant is important In climates where the temperature is above -37°C (-34°F) use
to long engine life. The following information provides a coolant mixture that contains 50 percent antifreeze.
recommendations for selecting the engine coolant and Antifreeze is essential in any climate. It broadens the
maintaining the coolant inhibitors. operating temperature range by lowering the coolant freezing
point and by raising its boiling point. Do not use more than 50
Heavy duty diesel engines require a balanced coolant mixture percent antifreeze in the mixture unless additional freeze
of water, antifreeze, and supplemental coolant additives. protection is required. Never use more than 68 percent
Supplemental coolant additive recommendations are included antifreeze under any condition.
in the section entitled Inhibitors Conditioners. The coolant
mixture must be drained and replaced at the specified service An antifreeze concentration greater than 68% will adversely
interval shown in the OPERATION & MAINTENANCE affect freeze protection and heat transfer rates. Antifreeze
MANUAL, or every two years of operation, whichever comes concentrations between 68 and 100% actually have a higher
first. freezing point than a 68% antifreeze concentration and should
not be used due to reduced heat transfer rates.
WATER
Low silicate ethylene glycol antifreeze is recommended. The
Use water which has a low mineral content. Water used in antifreeze should contain no more than 0.1% anhydrous alkali
conjunction with antifreeze, coolant filters and inhibited water metasilicate. Low silicate antifreeze is recommended to avoid
must meet the following standards: the formation of silica-gel (hydro-gel). This gel formation can
occur when the cooling system contains an over concentration
Total Hardness - Not to exceed 170 parts per million (10 of high silicate antifreeze and/or supplemental coolant
grains/gallon maximum) to prevent scale deposits. Water additive. DO NOT use methanol or alcohol as an antifreeze
containing dissolved magnesium and calcium (the usual because of its low boiling point.
reason for water hardness) above the specified amount will
cause scale deposits to develop in the engine. Antifreeze may retain its freeze protection for more than one
season but coolant conditioners must be added to maintain
Chlorides - Not to exceed 40 parts per million (2.5 corrosion protection.
grains/gallon maximum) to prevent corrosion.
Antifreeze formulated with methoxy propanol, or propylene
Sulfites - Not to exceed 100 parts per million (5.8 glycol, is not recommended for this system.
grains/gallon maximum) to prevent corrosion.
* Do not mix types of antifreeze solutions. Mixed solutions
Dissolved Solids - Not to exceed 340 parts per million (20 make it impossible to determine the protection against
grains/gallon maximum) to minimize sludge deposits, scale freezing. Antifreeze containing sealer or anti-leak additives
deposits, corrosion or a combination of these. should NOT be used in this system. Sealer or anti-leak
additives will cause plugging problems in the cooling system.
If any of the above requirements cannot be met, use distilled,
de-ionized, or de-mineralized water. To determine if local Check the solution periodically and at normal operating
water supplies meet these standards, water samples can be temperature, to be sure the cooling system has sufficient
tested by water treatment laboratories. Softened water that is protection against freezing.
prepared using common salt (sodium chloride) contains
excessive amounts of chlorides and should not be used. The following table shows the approximate percentage of
antifreeze solution required for various temperatures.
* Never use water alone in the cooling system because
corrosion will occur.
Percentage of Antifreeze
Approximate Freezing Point Specific Gravity at 16°C (60°F)
Concentration by Volume
01-10
GENERAL COOLANT SPECIFICATIONS
In tropical climates where antifreeze availability may be limited, Each time the coolant is drained and replaced, the coolant
use a corrosion inhibitor DCA4, to protect the engine cooling must be recharged with DCA4. New coolant can be correctly
system. charged with supplemental coolant additives by using DCA4
filters or DCA4 concentrate listed in the table entitled, DCA4
lNHlBlTORS/CONDlTlONERS Unit Guide.
1. All cooling system inhibitors, including those in antifreeze If coolant is added between drain intervals, additional DCA4
solutions, become depleted through normal operation. If will be required.
the inhibitors in antifreeze are allowed to become
depleted, the antifreeze becomes corrosive and attacks Coolant Testing for Conditioner Concentration
and coats the metallic surfaces of the cooling system
which reduces heat transfer. Cooling system conditioners When the cooling system is maintained as recommended, the
which contain these inhibitors must be added to maintain conditioner concentration should be satisfactory. The DCA4
corrosion protection. concentration must not fall below 1 .O unit per 3.8 Q (1 USgal)
or exceed 2 units per 3.8 Q (1 USgal) of coolant. The only
2. Soluble oil is not recommended for use in this engine as accurate method for testing chemical concentrations in coolant
its use will reduce heat transfer. with mixed chemical compounds is a laboratory analysis. For
this reason, the coolant inhibitor should be maintained as
3. There are no miracle additives that will increase heat shown in the OPERATION & MAINTENANCE MANUAL.
transfer or prevent overheating. Conditioned water is still
the best coolant. * Inadequate concentration of the coolant additive can
result in major corrosive damage to cooling system
4. DCA4 is recommended to inhibit corrosion in the cooling components. Over concentration can cause formation of gel
system for the following reasons: that can cause restriction, plugging of passages and
overheating.
l Improved compatibility with high silicate antifreezes to
minimize hydro-gel formation if over concentration occurs. Replenishing Coolant Conditioner
l Provides engine protection in the following areas: Install a precharge DCA4 filter when the coolant is changed or
- Solder corrosion/bloom a significant (more than 50%) coolant loss occurs. Install a
- Copper corrosion/erosion/stress cracking service DCA4 filter as specified in the OPERATION &
- Oil fouling MAINTENANCE MANUAL When antifreeze is added, add
- Cylinder liner cavitation corrosion coolant conditioner equal to 1.0 unit per 3.8 Q (1 USgal) of
- Aluminum cavitation corrosion antifreeze.
- Seal and gasket degradation
Mixing of DCA4 and other supplemental coolant additives is
Maintenance of Cooling System Inhibitors not recommended because there is currently no test kit
available to measure concentration levels with mixed chemical
Keeping the engine coolant properly inhibited will keep the solutions.
engine and radiator free of rust, scale deposits and corrosion.
DCA4 Unit Maintenance Guide
New machines are delivered with antifreeze protection.
Service at regular scheduled intervals specified in the Use supplemental coolant additives (corrosion inhibitors) to
OPERATION & MAINTENANCE MANUAL with a service protect the engine cooling system from corrosion. Antifreeze
DCA4 filter. alone does not provide enough corrosion protection for a
heavy duty diesel engine. Supplemental corrosion protection
01-11
GENERAL COOLANT SPECIFICATIONS
System Capacity
Precharge Filter Service Filter
(See NOTE 1) (See NOTE 3)
Liters US GALLONS
01-12
GENERAL COOLANT SPECIFICATIONS
NOTE 1 - After draining and replacing coolant, always required to precharge the cooling system. Four bottles of
precharge the cooling system to maintain the powder, part number DCA95, will provide a sufficient amount
DCA4 concentration between 1 .O and 2.0 units per of DCA4 units (80) to precharge the example cooling system.
3.8 Q(1 USgal).
l Install the appropriate service filter at the next and
* When performing service which requires draining the subsequent maintenance intervals.
cooling system, discard the coolant. Reusing coolant
can introduce contaminates or over concentrated chemicals, NOTE 3 - Change the coolant filter at every engine oil and
resulting in premature failure of cooling system components. filter change interval to protect the cooling system.
l The answer represents the additional units To check the DCA4 concentration level, use the Fleetguard
coolant test kit, CC2626. Instructions are included with the test
kit.
01-13
GENERAL COOLANT SPECIFICATIONS
The following may be purchased from your Komatsu America Company distributor.
01-14
10 STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION
Power train .............................. 10 -3 Work equipment hydraulic circuit diagram .... 1O-l 03
Power train system ....................... 10 -4 Work equipment lever linkage ............. 1O-l 07
Torque converter, transmission piping ........ IO -6 Hydraulic tank .......................... 1O-l 08
Transmission hydraulic system diagram ...... 10 -8 PPCvalve ............................. IO-110
Transmission hydraulic circuit diagram ....... 10 -9 PPC reliefvalve ......................... IO-115
Torque converter ......................... 1O-l 0 Accumulator (for PPC valve) .............. 1O-l 16
Torque converter oil filter .................. 1O-l 2 Main control valve ....................... 1O-l 18
Transmission ............................ 1 O-l 4 Work equipment linkage .................. 1O-l 34
Transmission control valve ................. 1O-26 Bucket ................................ 1O-l 36
Driveshaft .............................. IO-48 Bucket positioner and boom kick-out ........ 1O-l 37
Axle ................................... IO-49 Cab................................... lO-14 3
Differential .............................. 1 O-51 Air conditioner .......................... 1O-144
Final drive ............................... 1O-55 Electric circuit diagram ................... 1O-l 45
Axle mount center hinge ................... 1O-56 Machine monitor system .................. 1 O-l 58
Steering piping ........................... 1O-58 Main monitor ........................... 1O-l 59
Steering column ......................... 1O-59 Maintenance monitor ..................... 1O-l 63
Priority valve ............................. 1O-60 E.C.S.S. (Electronic controlled
Steering valve (orbit-roll) ................... 1O-65 suspension system) ............ 1O-l 65
Cushion valve ........................... 1O-74 Sensors ............................... 1O-l 69
2-way restrictor valve ...................... 1O-75 Engine starting circuit .................... 1O-l 73
Brake piping ............................. 1O-76 Engine stop circuit ....................... 1O-l 74
Brake hydraulic circuit diagram .............. 1O-77 Ether start circuit ........................ 1O-l 75
Brake valve ............................. 1O-78 Electric transmission control ............... 1O-l 76
Accumulator charge valve ................. 1O-83 Kick-down switch ........................ 1O-l 79
Accumulator (for brake) ................... 1O-87 Kick-down electric circuit diagram .......... 1O-l 80
Brake .................................. IO-89 Transmission cut -off switch ............... 1O-l 85
Parking brake control ..................... 1 O-92 Transmission cut-off function .............. 1O-l 86
Parking brake1 ........................... 1O-93 Electric parking brake control .............. 1O-l 88
Parking brake solenoid valve ............... 1O-94
Parking brake valve ....................... 1O-95
Parking emergency release solenoid valve .... IO-96
Hydraulic piping .......................... 1O-98
Work equipment hydraulic system diagram ... 1O-l 01
1O-l
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION POWER TRAIN
POWER TRAIN
4 5 6 7
Outline
l The motive force from engine (3) passes through . The motive force from the output shaft of the
the engine flywheel and is transmitted to the torque transmission passes through center drive shaft (6)
converter (2), which is connected to the input shaft front drive shaft (5) and rear drive shaft (7) and is
of transmission (1). then transmitted to front axle (4) and rear axle (8)
l The transmission has six hydraulically actuated to drive the wheels.
clutches, and these provide four speed ranges for
both FORWARD and REVERSE. The transmission
speed ranges are selected manually.
1o-3
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION POWER TRAIN SYSTEM
I I%w=
16' 15 14 13 12
1 o-4
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION POWER TRAIN SYSTEM
Outline
The motive force from engine (17) passes through
1. Front tire the flywheel and is transmitted to torque converter
2. Final drive (18).
The torque converter uses oil as a medium. It
3. Wet type disc brake converts the transmitted torque in accordance with
4. Differential the change in load, and transmits the motive force
to the input shaft of the transmission.
5. Front axle In addition, the motive force of the engine passes
6.. Front drive shaft through the pump drive gear of the torque
converter, and is transmitted to hydraulic, steering
7. Flange bearing switch, PPC Pump (19) and torque converter
8. Center drive shaft charging pump (20) to drive each pump.
Transmission (10) operates the directional spool
9. Parking brake and speed spool of the transmission valve through
10. Transmission the solenoid valves, and actuates the six
hydraulically actuated clutches to select one of the
11. Rear drive shaft four FORWARD or REVERSE speeds.
12. Final drive The transmission speed range is selected
manually.
13. Wet type disc brake The output shaft of the transmission (10) transmit
14. Differential the power to the front and rear axles. At the front
the power is transmitted to front axle (5) through
15. Rear axle center drive shaft (8), flange bearing (7) and front
16 Rear tire drive shaft (6).
At the rear, the power is transmitted to rear axle
17. Engine (S6D114E-1) (15) through rear drive shaft (11).
18. Torque converter The motive force transmitted to front axle (5)and
rear axle (15) has its speed reduced by the bevel
19. Hydraulic steering switch, PPC pump gear and pinion gear of differentials (4) and (14),
20. Torque converter charging pump and is then transmitted to the sun gear shaft
through the differential mechanism.
The motive force of sun gear is reduce further by
the planetary mechanism and is transmitted to the
wheels through the axle shaft.
1o-5
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TORQUE CONVERTER, TRANSMISSION PIPING
sBwoo422
IO-6
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION HYDRAULIC SYSTEM DIAGRAM
-
-
SBWO0423
IO-8
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
P__&_____--__“___--_:_______L_____
,
_-
- 1 I
22
I
m I
3: t 23
:
1 (Oakgkd) 7 1 u I
e--- .-*, . ,I .mIrl. 19 I II IL
26
27
b 2.9MPi
CKIks/m2)
bib 28
1. Transmission case 13. Solenoid valve (3rd, 4th) 22. 1st clutch
2. Strainer 14. Solenoid valve (FORWARD, 23. 2nd clutch
3. Hydraulic pump (SAL40+20) 2nd) 24. 3rd clutch
4. Oil filter 15. Solenoid valve (REVERSE, 25. 4th clutch
5. Pilot reducing valve 2nd) 26. REVERSE clutch
6. Modulation valve 16. Solenoid valve (parking 27. FORWARD clutch
7. Quick return valve brake) 28. Parking brake
8. Main relief valve 17. Range selector valve 29. Torque converter
9. Emergency manual spool 18. H-L selector valve 30. Oil cooler
10. Pilot oil filter 19. Directional selector valve 31. Transmission lubrication
11. Priority valve 20. Parking brake valve 32. Torque converter outlet
12. Solenoid valve (lst, 4th) 21. Accumulator valve
SLWO04.24
1o-9
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TORQUE CONVERTER
TORQUE CONVERTER
2 7
3 Y// I
IO-IO
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TORQUE CONVERTER
SAW00428
Flow of oil
l the oil supplied from the torque converter charging
pump enters inlet port A, passes through the oil
passage of stator shaft (8) and flows to pump (5).
The oil is given centrifugal force by pump (5), enters
turbine (2) and transmits the energy of the oil to the
turbine Turbine (2) is fixed to transmission input
shaft.(l I), so the motive force is transmitted to the
transmission input shaft.
The oil from turbine (2) is sent to stator (3) and
enters the pump again. However, part of the oil is
sent from the stator through outlet port B to the
cooler.
5
SWAOO429
IO-II
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TORQUE CONVERTER OIL FILTER
1. Relief valve
2. Element
3. Center bolt
4. Drain plug
Specifications
Filter mesh size: 10 microns
filtering area: 8900 cm*
Relief pressure: 0.34 Mpa (3.5 kg/cm*)
sEwooo14
* E&mission
Operation control valve
l The oil from the torque converter charging pump
enters filter inlet port A It is filtered from outside of
element (2) to the inside, and flows to outlet port B.
TO
transmission
control valve
If element (2) becomes clogged with dirt, or the oil
temperature is low and the pressure rises at inlet port
A, the oil from inlet port A opens relief valve (1) and
flows directly to outlet port B in order to prevent
damage to the pump or element (2).
IO-12
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION
TRANSMISSION
E4 I
‘6
IO-14
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION
9 IO
II -
1s 15 13
A-A
IO-16
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION
1. Transmission case
2. Transmission control valve
3. Accumulator valve
4. Oil filter
5. Torque converter charging pump
(SAL (2) 40 + 20)
6. Transmission oil filter
7. REVERSE Clutch
8. FORWARD clutch
9. Input shaft
10. Torque converter
11. 3rd clutch
12. 4th clutch
13. Rear coupling
14. Output shaft
15. Parking brake
16. Front coupling
17.2nd, 4th shaft
18. 2nd clutch
19. lst, 3rd shaft
20. 1st clutch
21. REVERSE idler gear
22. Strainer
E-E
399993R
IO-17
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION
Outline
. The transmission is installed behind the torque l The transmission uses the combination of the
converter. The motive force from the torque forward or reverse clutches and the four speed
converter passes through the transmission input clutches to shift Fl - 4 or RI - 4. And transmits the
shaft and enters the transmission motive force from the input shaft to the output
shaft.
CLUTCH
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 b 8
a C
IO-18
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION
_____-__-__- ____‘, :
I
_-‘~-__-__-__-__-“__-__~i__
I C
b Y
_ _______ -__-__-_ _-___- _____ -__-__-_ ----ok_-
r In1 n
-I!!3 w I
IO-19
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION
Operation of clutch
When operated 5 6 2 3 4 1
l The oil sent from the transmission valve passes
through the oil passage inside shaft (I), and goes
to the rear face of piston (6) to actuate the piston.
l When piston (6) is actuated, separator plate (2) is
pressed against clutch disc (3) and forms shaft (1)
clutch gear (4) into one unit to transmit the motive
force
l Oil is drained from the oil drain hole (5) at this time,
but this does not affect the clutch operation since
less oil is drained than supplied.
1O-20
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION
FORWARD 1ST
8
32
25
d’ \I I I II II I III I
ut /I I II II I ill I
34 14 sAw00430
Operation
l In forward 1st forward clutch (8) and 1st clutch (20) l Since the first clutch is engaged, the motive force
are engaged. The motive force from the torque transmitted to 1st and 3rd gear (32) is transmitted
converter transmitted to input shaft (9) is from 1st gear (25) via the 1st clutch to 2nd and 4th
transmitted to output shaft (14). gear (33), then transmitted to output shaft (14) via
l The clutch discs of forward clutch (8) and 1st (20) 2nd and 4th shaft (17), idler gear (31) and output
are held by hydraulic pressure applied to the piston. gear (34).
l The motive force from the torque converter is
transmitted to input shaft (9) via forward clutch (8)
to forward gear (23) then transmitted to 1st and 3rd
gear (32).
1o-21
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION
32
26
18
Operation
. In forward 2(nd), forward clutch (8) and 2nd clutch 1st and 3rd gear (32) 1st nd 3rd shaft (19) and idler
(18) are engaged. The motive force from the torque gear (29) to 2nd gear (26). Since the 2nd clutch (18) is
converter transmitted to input shaft (9) is engaged, the motive force transmitted to the 2nd gear
transmitted to output shaft (14). is transmitted from 2nd and 4th gear (33) via the 2nd
l The clutch disc of forward clutch (8) and 2nd clutch clutch to output shaft (14) via 4th shaft (17), idler gear
(18) are held by hydraulic pressure applied to the (31) and output gear (34).
clutch piston .
l The motive e force from the torque converter is
transmitted from input shaft (9) via forward clutch
(8) to forward gear (23) then transmitted via
1o-22
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION
FORWARD 3RD
32
‘30
34 14 SAW00441
Operation
In forward 3rd, forward clutch (8) and 3rd clutch l Since 3rd clutch (11) is engaged, the motive force
(11) are engaged. The motive force from the torque transmitted to 1st and 3rd gear (32) is transmitted
converter transmitted to input shaft (9) is from 3rd gear (27) via the 3rd clutch, then to
transmitted to output shaft (14). output shaft (14) via 2nd and 4th shaft (17) idler
The clutch discs of forward clutch (8) and 3rd clutch gear (31) and output gear (34).
(11) are held by the hydraulic pressure applied to
the clutch piston.
The motive force from the torque converter is
transmitted from input shaft (9) via forward clutch
(8) to forward gear (23) then to 1st and 3rd gear
(32).
IO-23
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION
FORWARD 4TH
8 23
\ i
\
28
SAW00 442
Operation
In forward 4th, forward clutch (8) and 4th clutch . Since 4th clutch is engaged, the motive force
(12) are engaged. The motive force from the transmitted to 4th gear is transmitted from 2nd and
torque converter transmitted to input shaft (9) is 4th gear (33) via the 4th clutch, then to output
transmitted to output shaft (14). shaft (14) via 2nd and 4th shaft (17) idler gear
The clutch discs of forward clutch (8) and 4th (31) and output gear (34).
clutch (12) are held by the hydraulic pressure
applied to the clutch piston.
The motive force from the torque converter is
transmitted from input shaft (9) via forward clutch
(8) to forward gear (23) then transmitted via 1st
and 3rd gear (32) to 4th gear (28).
IO-24
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION
19
25
34 i4 SAW00443
Operation
. In reverse 1st reverse clutch (7) and 1st clutch The direction of rotation is reversed by idler gear (21),
(20) are engaged. The motive force from the and the motive force is then transmitted to 1st and 3rd
torque converter transmitted to input shaft (9) is gear (32) via idler gear (29) and 1st and 3rd shaft (19).
transmitted to output shaft (14). Since the 1st clutch is engaged, the motive force
l The clutch disc of reverse clutch (7) and 1st clutch transmitted to 1st and 3rd gear (32) is transmitted from
(20) are held by the hydraulic pressure applied to 1st gear (25) via the 1st clutch to 2nd and 4th gear
the piston. (33), then transmitted to output shaft (14) via the 2nd
. the motive force from the torque converter is and 4th shaft, idler gear (31) and output gear (34).
transmitted from the input shaft (9).via reverse
clutch (7) to reverse gear (24).
1o-25
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
I I I \
a 9 f b a. From pump
b. To oil cooler
C. Clutch oil pressure measure-
5
ment port
d. Main oil pressure measure-
ment port
e. Torque converter inlet port
oil pressure measurement
Port
f. Torque converter outlet port
oil pressure measurement
Port
1. Lower valve 9 Parking brake oil pressure
2. Upper valve measurement port (priority
3. Emergency manual spool measurement port)
4. Pilot oil filter h. Pilot oil pressure measure-
5. Modulation valve ment port
sBwoo444
Outline
The oil from the pump passes through the oil filter The oil which flows into the parking braking brake
and enters the transmission control valve. The oil circuit controls the parking brake release oil
is divided by the priority valve and passes into the pressure through the parking brake valve.
pilot circuit, parking brake circuit and clutch The oil which flows into the clutch operation circuit
operation circuit. passes through the main relief valve, its pressure
The priority valve controls the flow so that the oil is regulated with the modulation valve, and this oil
flows with priority into the pilot circuit and parking actuates the clutch. The oil released by the main
brake circuit to keep the oil pressure constant. relief valve is supplied to the torque converter..
the constant pressure of the oil which flows into The modulation valve smoothly increases the
the pilot circuit is regulated by the pilot pressure clutch oil pressure when shifting gears by the
reducing valve, and this is the oil pressure which action of the quick return valve and accumulator,
actuates the FORWARD/REVERSE, H/L range thereby reducing gear-shifting shock.
and parking brake spools when the solenoids turn An accumulator valve is installed to reduce time
ON and OFF. lag and shocks when shifting gears.
IO-26
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
UPPER VALVE
A-A
IO-27
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
LOWER VALVE
‘6
i A-A SAWQQ44S
IO-28
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
Operation tich
tb 3t
1. Solenoid valve OFF -
The oil from pilot reducing valve (1) flows to ports
a and b of H-L selector spool (2) and range
selector spool (3). The oil at a and b is blocked
by solenoid valves (4) and (5) so selector spools
(2) and (3) are moved to the right in the direction
of arrow.
As a result, the oil from the pump flows to the 2nd
clutch.
2. Solenoid valve ON
When the speed lever is operated, the drain ports
of solenoid valves (4) and (5) open.
Frompump
The oil at ports a and b of selector spools (2) and a 3 e 6
SBWOO450
From pump
IO-29
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
Function
. The pilot reducing valve controls the pressure to
actuate the directional selector spool, H-L selector
spool, range selector spool, and parking brake
spool.
Operation
. The oil from the pump enters port a, passes
through port b of pilot reducing spool (1) enters
spools (2) and (3) in the lower valve, and fills the Solenoid
~valve
pilot circuit.
The oil at port b passes through the orifice and
flows to port c.
SBwOO45l
From pump
From pump 2
Solenoid valve
From pump
1O-30
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
Function To clutch
circuit To torqueconverter
l The main relief valve regulates the pressure of the
oil flowing to the clutch circuit and distributes the 8 6
oil flow between the clutch circuit and the torque B
converter.
I
1/ I#y -
1
Q A
From priority valve
Operation
1. The oil from the pump passes through the priority
valve, the through ports A and B until the main Todutch
circuit To torqueconverter
relief valve (1) specified pressure is reached, and
flows to the clutch valve.
IO-31
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
Function
l The torque converter outlet port valve is installed
in the outlet line of the torque converter and
adjusts the maximum pressure of the torque
converter.
Operation
l The oil at port a passes through the orifice in spool From torque. converter To cooler
(1) and flows to port c.
a, 4 t
. If the pressure at port a becomes even higher, From torque converter To cooler
spool (1) is moved further to the left in the direction
of the arrow, and the oil flows from port a to port b
and drain port d. (Cold relief)
1o-32
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
PRIORITY VALVE
Function 1
l The priority valve regulates the pump’s discharge
pressure and provides the pilot oil pressure and
parking brake release oil pressure.
. If the pressure in the circuit reaches a level above From
the measured oil pressure, the priority valve acts pump
as a relief valve, releasing the pressure to protect
the hydraulic circuitry.
Operation
+ +
1. The oil from the pump enters port a and separates Tomain To pilot
into the oil flowing to the parking brake valve (I), reliefvalve valve
+ +
To n&n To pilot
relief valve valve
1o-33
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
Operation
1. After engine is started, clutch completely
engaged (clutch pressure at point A)
I brake valve
I
2nd dutch
Oil filter
Accumulator valve 4th clutch
FORWARD
clutch
1o-34
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
or
a\
6,
7-
b-
St clutch
B
Oil cooler
S
rorque converter
2nd cbtch
_ i Fromarxfato
b’
463
When the directional lever is shifted from As a result, the oil pressure at port a of return
FORWARD to REVERSE, FORWARD solenoid (1) valve (6) drops, check valve (7) opens, and the oil
closes and REVERSE solenoid (2) opens. at port b flowsto port a.
Directional spool (3) is moved to the right in the At the same time, quick return valve (6) is moved
direction of the arrow and the oil at FORWARD to the left in the direction of the arrow by the
clutch (4) is drained from the drain circuit. accumulator oil pressure, and the oil in
At the same time, the oil from the pump flows to
accumulator (8) is drained suddenly from port C.
REVERSE clutch (5), but while the oil is filling the
l Accumulator (8) is returned to the right end by
inside of the clutch, the clutch oil pressure drops.
force of spring (9).
1o-35
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
lector
-- 2nd clutch
-r
Oil cooler
Torque converter
3rd clutch
SBW00454
l The oil from the pump fills the REVERSE clutch a From accumulator
and the clutch circuit pressure starts to rise.
As a result, the pressure a port a rises and quick
return valve (6) is moved to the right in the
direction of the arrow to close drain port c.
SAW00465
IO-36
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
ON
-
LQ-I
ON
1o-37
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
Operation
1. When at neutral
From pilot reducing valve
l Solenoid valve (4) and (5) are OFF and the drain
Accumulatorvalve
port is closed. The oil from the pilot circuit passes + -
through the oil hole in the emergency manual FORWARD clutch
spool and fills ports a and b of the directional
spool.
. In this condition, PI + spring force (1) = PZ
+spring force (2) so the balance is maintained.
Therefore the oil at port C does not go to the
FORWARD or REVERSE clutch.
-modulation
valve
IO-38
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
Operation
2nd clutch
4th dutch
1. 2nd speed
. When solenoid valves (1) and (2) are OFF, the
drain port is closed. The oil PI from the pilot
circuit overcomes the force of the H-L selector
spool (4) and range selector spool (5) springs (3)
and moves spools (4) and (5) to the left. The oil in
clutch circuit passes from H-L selector spool (4)
port a through range selector spool (5) port b and
is supplied to the 2nd clutch.
1o-39
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
From
modulation valve From
SBWOO47l
pilot valve
1O-40
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
Function
. Should the electric system malfunction and the
forward/reverse solenoid valves cannot be
actuated, the emergency manual spool actuates
the forward and reverse clutches manually.
Operation
1. When the emergency manual spool is at
neutral (during normal operation)
l The oil from the pilot valve passes through
emergency manual spool (I), enters the lower
valve directional spool (2) port “a”,and “b”and is
sealed by forward solenoid valve (3).
a
directional spool (2) port “a”,not into port ‘lb”.
‘R Eclutch
This generates a pressure difference between
a
ports “a” and “ b”, directional spool (2) moves to
the left, oil flows into the forward clutch and the
clutch is engaged. From
c c modulation
- va’ve
SBWO0473
IO-41
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
MODULATION VALVE
A-A
1. Valve body
2. Fill valve
3. Accumulator
SAW00474
1o-42
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
Function
l The modulation valves consists of a fill valve and an
Clutch
accumulator. It controls the pressure and flow of the
oil flowing to the clutch and increases the clutch ----
pressure.
I Accuniulator
Fill valve t
From priority From torgue
valve converter outlet
valve
1o-43
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
1o-44
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
ACCUMULATOR VALVE
t--B
B-B
12 6
‘7
10’ 9’ ‘8
SAW00697
A-A
1o-45
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
Operation
1. Shifting down when digging (kick-down F2+Fl)
When the transmission is in F2, oil pressure is stored 1st clutch oi\pressure
2nf clutch oil pressure
in the 2nd clutch accumulator. t
When the kick-down is operated, the Fl clutch is 0)
engaged, but the oil pressure in the accumulator is 5
% Oil pressure
maintained for the 2nd clutch until the torque is maintained so
transmitted to the 1st clutch. In this way, it is remains of torque
possible to shift gears smoothly without losing the
torque.
Moving out after digging (Fl+R2) FORWARD clutch oil REVERSE clutch oil
When the transmission is in Fl, oil pressure is stored pressure, 1st clutch pressure, 2nd clutch
oil pressure oil pressure ,
in the accumulator for the FORWARD clutch and 1st I
t
clutch. ?!
When shifting to R2 after completing digging z Oil pressure
operations, the R2 clutch is engaged, but the oil : maintained so
torqe is lowered
pressure for the FORWARD clutch and 1st clutch is %
maintained in the accumulator. This makes it r0
possible to reduce the loss of torque due to the 5
5
rreactionforce to the product being handled, and to
move back smoothly without shock.
SDWOOO41
IO-46
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
1. Case Specifications
2. Element Filtering area: 170 cm*
3. Oil filter heat Filter mesh size: 105 p
A. Inlet port
B. Outlet port
SBWOO482
Outline
. The pilot oil filter is mounted on the transmission
lower valve, and filters dirt from the oil flowing to the
pilot circuit.
1o-47
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION DRIVE SHAFT
DRIVE SHAFT
SBWOO698
IO-48
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION AXLE
AXLE
FRONT AXLE
Ii
2 3 4 5 6 7
A-A
SAW00999
1o-49
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION
REAR AXLE
2 3 4 5 6 7
1
A-A
a
1. Oil supply port and level plug
2. Coupling
3. Differential
4. Wet-type, single disc brake
5. Final drive
6. Axle housing
7. Axle shaft
6. Drain plug
1O-50
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION DIFFERENTIAL
DIFFERENTIAL
FRONT DIFFERENTIAL
1o-51
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION DIFFERENTIAL
REAR DIFFERENTIAL
1o-52
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION DIFFERENTIAL
Outline
The motive force from the engine is transmitted to
the front and rear axles via the torque converter, the
transmission and the propeller shaft.
In the axle, the motive force is transmitted from bevel
pinion (1) to bevel gear (5), shifted 90’ and reduced,
and transmitted to sun gear shaft (2) via pinion gear
(4).
The motive force of the sun gear is further reduced
by planetary gear-type final drive, and transmitted to
the axle shaft and wheel.
When slewing
l When slewing, the speed of rotation of the left and
right wheels is unequal, so pinion gear (4) and side
gear (3) in the differential assembly rotate according
to the difference in the left and right rotation speeds,
and the motive force of carrier (6) is transmitted to
the sun gear shafts (2).
1o-53
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION DIFFERENTIAL
Operation
When traveling straight (equal resistance from road
surface to left and right tires)
l If the resistance from the road surface to the left and
right wheels is the same, the distance between
pinion gear (4) and meshing point “a” of left side
gear (7) is the same as the distance between pinion
gear (4) and meshing point “b” of right side gear (3).
. Therefore the left side traction TL and the right side
traction TR are balanced.
1o-54
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION FINAL DRIVE
FINAL DRIVE
1. 2
Outline
l As the final function the final drive operates to
reduce the rotative speed of the motive force from
the engine and increases the driving force.
. Ring gear (4) is press-fitted in the axle housing and
fixed in place by a pin.
l The motive force transmitted from the differential to
the sun gear shaft (5) is reduced using a planetary
gear mechanism, increasing the driving force.
The increased driving force is transmitted to the tires
via planetary gear (2) and axle shaft
(3).
SAW00704
1o-55
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION AXLE MOUNT, CENTER HINGE PIN
I. Front axle
A-A B-B
2. Rear axle
3. Front frame
4. Rear frame
5. Upper hinge pin
6. Lower hinge pin
SBW00705
IO-56
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION AXLE MOUNT, CENTER HINGE PIN
IO-57
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION STEERING PIPING
STEERING PIPING
1. Steering cylinder
2. Steering valve
3. Hydraulic tank
4. Hydraulic pump
5. Oil cooler
6. Priority valve
SAW01255
7. Main control valve
1O-58
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION STEERING COLUMN
STEERING COLUMN
L---)
a4J ..*.:.d
-J
L /
I
A--
/-
--
-i
,/
3
=ii___
-__-. ::U
-b
-------__- _________
------- _________ ___
______-_____-__-__-
- ----- - -____ -______
1. Steering wheel
2. Steering column SBW00708
3. Joint
1o-59
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION PRIORITY VALVE
PRIORITY VALVE
(FOR STEERING PUMP CIRCUIT)
A--l
I[
R
Cl 0
1. Plug
2. Return spring
3. Plug
4. Relief valve body
5. Spring guide
6. Valve spring
7. Ball holder
8. Ball
9. Screen
10. Spool
11. Valve body
A. To steering valve
B. To oil cooler
C. From steering valve
D. Drain
E. From steering pump
F. To priority valve D
(for switch pump circuit)
G. To priority valve C
(for switch pump circuit)
10 68G7 6 5
SAW00709
Outline
l The priority valve is in the circuit between the
steering pump and the steering valve. It acts to
divide the flow of oil from the steering pump and
send it to the steering valve or oil cooler circuit. It
also sets the oil pressure in the circuit from the
priority valve to the steering valve to 20.6 MPa (210
kg/cm2) to protect the circuit.
IO-60
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION PRIORITY VALVE
A-1
1. Plug
2. Return spring
3. Plug
4. Plug
5. Spool
6. Valve body
A. To steering valve
B. To main control valve
C. From priority valve G
(for steering circuit)
D. From priority valve F
(for steering circuit)
E. From switch pump
5’ E’ ‘4
A-A
SAW00710
Outline
l The priority valve is in the circuit from the switch
pump to the steering valve and main control valve.
It acts to divide the oil flow from the switch pump and
send it to the steering valve or work equipment
circuit.
IO-61
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION PRIORITY VALVE
Operation
/
ml
Ml SLWOl256
From skiitch pump SUVO1256
IO-62
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION PRIORITY VALVE
pump
Towork
IO-63
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION PRIORITY VALVE
SLW01258
From switch pump
IO-64
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION STEERING VALVE
a b
1. Ground
2. Valve body
3. Check valve
4. Rotor
5. Stator
6. Spacer
7. Cover
8. Spacer
9. Drive shaft
10. Sleeve
A-A
11. Center pin
a. To hydraulic tank 12. Spool
b. To steering cylinder 13. Center spring
c. To steering cylinder 14. Check valve
d. From steering pump 15. Overload valve
SBW007l4
IO-65
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION STEERING VALVE
Outline
l The steering valve is connected directly to the shaft
of the steering wheel. It switches the flow of oil from
the steering pump to the left and right steering
cylinders to determine the direction of travel of the
machine.
9 The steering valve, broadly speaking, consists of the
following components: rotary type spool (3) and
sleeve (5) which have the function of selecting the
direction, and the Girotor set (a combination of rotor
(8) and stator (9)) which acts as a hydraulic motor
during normal steering operations, and as a hand
pump (in fact, the operating force of the steering
wheel is too high, so it cannot be operated) when the
steering pump or engine have failed and the supply
of oil has stopped.
Structure
Spool (3) is directly connected to the drive shaft of
the steering wheel, and is connected to sleeve (5) by
center pin (4) (it does not contact the spool when the
steering wheel is at neutral) and centering spring
(12).
The top of drive shaft (6) is meshed with center pin
(4) and forms one unit with sleeve (5) while the
bottom of the drive shaft is meshed with the spline of
rotor (8) of the Girotor.
There are four ports in valve body (2), and they are
connected to the pump circuit, tank circuit, and the
circuits at the head end and bottom end of the
steering cylinders. The pump port and tank port are
connected by the check valve inside the body. If the
pump or engine fail, the oil can be sucked in directly
from the tank by this check valve.
.8
SBWOO718
1O-66
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION STEERING VALVE
Operation
1. Steering wheel at neutral
Switch pu
RiOW
valve
SAWOOT19
1O-68
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION STEERING VALVE
m Sleeve hole
:
1-1
s?? From pump
From priority valve :;: , El3
Sleeve Spool
/
KL
z-z
SW00902
H J K SBWO0722
1O-69
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION STEERING VALVE
Switch pu
-
SAW00723
1O-70
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION STEERING VALVE
Spool groove
0 hole To priority valve
@ Sleeve hole
l When the steering wheel is turned to the left, spool flows from port G to the head end of the right cylinder.
(3) which is connected by the spline of the steering The oil entering vertical groove B passes through orifice
shaft, also turns to the left. The spool and sleeve (5) b and flows to port J. From port J, it becomes the pilot
are interconnected by centering spring (12) so the pressure of the priority valve.
spool compresses the centering spring. The oil from the head end of the left cylinder enters
Therefore, a difference in the angle of rotation (angle vertical groove D from port F and is drained to the
variation) is generated between the spool and sleeve hydraulic tank.
equal to the amount that the centering spring is 3. Steering wheel stopped
compressed. When the operation of the steering wheel is stopped, the
When this happens, first, port A and vertical groove difference in rotation between the spool and sleeve is
B are connected. Then vertical groove B and returned to the neutral condition by the reaction of
port E to the Girotor, and port E from the Girotor to centering spring (12)
vertical groove C are connected. Finally, vertical
groove C and port G to the head end of the right
cylinder are connected.
In addition, vertical groove B is kept connected to
orifice b of port J to the priority valve, but port K of
the sleeve gradually closes the connection of vertical
groove B and port L.
Port F from the head end of the left cylinder is
connected to vertical groove D (connected to drain
port H) at the same time as port A and vertical
groove B are connected.
. By shutting off and connecting the above ports and
grooves, the oil from the pump enters vertical groove
B from port A, then flows to port E to the Girotor, and
turns the Girotor. The oil discharged from the
Girotor enters vertical groove C from port E’ and
IO-71
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION STEERING VALVE
SBW00726
SBW00720
IO-72
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION STEERING VALVE
.-
SBWOO730
1o-73
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION CUSHION VALVE
CUSHION VALVE
1 2 3 A
i 6
B-B
A-A
Outline
. When there is a reaction to the sudden rise in the pressure on the steering, and the steering operates as normal.
of the steering cylinder, the cushion valve acts to prevent . When the pressure rises slowly and there is no need for any
shock by relieving the momentary high pressure oil to cushion effect, spool (8) closes more quickly than poppet
another line. (4) opens, so there is no unnecessary cushion action.
Function
. If high pressure oil suddenly enters from port R, the high
pressure oil compresses spring (3), and pushes open
poppet (4). It then passes through the center groove of
spool (S), goes through poppet (11) of port L, and flows
to port L.
. At the same time, the high pressure oil passes through
orifice (5) and goes to the pressure chamber of plug (6).
When it becomes greater than the pressure at port L and
the force of spring (7), it pushes spool (8) fully to the left.
This shuts off the flow of high pressure oil from port R
through poppet (4) to port L. This temporary flow of oil
has a cushion effect. The valve is not actuated any
further, so there is no effect
1o-74
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION 2-WAY RESTRICTOR VALVE
1. Tube 4. Poppet
2. Union 5. Tube
3. Body SBWQO732
Function
l To reduce the shock caused by the inertia of the
machine when the steering is operated, an orifice is
provided in the return circuit from the cylinder. This
gives pressure to the returning oil and acts to control
the movement of the cylinder piston.
Operation
l When the oil is flowing to the left in the direction of
the arrow, it pushes open poppet (3), and the oil
flows from the poppet orifice and the poppet notch.
. When the oil is flowing to the right in the direction of
the arrow, the oil flows only from portion a of the
poppet orifice, so the oil flow is restricted.
SBW00733
1o-75
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION BRAKE PIPING
BRAKE PIPING
IO-76
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION BRAKE HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
1
IA
IB
5 8
J
1. Hydraulic pump 6. Rear brake accumulator 16A. Parking brake emergency
IA. Work equipment pump 7. Front brake accumulator release solenoid
1B. Steering pump 8. Emergency brake switch 17. Parking brake emergency
1C. Switch pump 9. Left brake valve release switch
ID. PPC and brake pump 10. Transmission cut-off switch 18. Parking brake
2. Strainer 11. Right brake valve 19. Parking brake pilot lamp
3. Accumulator charge valve 12. Pilot lamp switch switch
3A. Safety relief valve 13. Accumulator 20. Parking brake solenoid
3B. PPC relief valve 14. Rear brake cylinder 21. Parking brake valve
4. Check valve 15. Front brake cylinder 22. Transmission pump
5. Low pressure switch 16. Emergency parking brake 23. Parking brake switch
valve
1o-77
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION BRAKE VALVE
BRAKE VALVE
BRAKE VALVE (RIGHT)
IO-78
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION BRAKE VALVE
Outline
l There are two brake valves installed in parallel under In addition, the left brake pedal operates the transmission
the front of the operator’s cab, and these are cut-off switch to actuate the transmission solenoid valve
actuated by depressing the pedal. electrically and set the transmission to neutral.
l When the right pedal is depressed, oil is sent to the
brake cylinder to apply the brakes.
. When the left pedal is depressed, oil is sent to the
right pedal to apply the brakes in the same way as
when the right pedal is depressed.
1o-79
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION BRAKE VALVE
Operation
Brake applied (right brake valve)
Upper portion
l When brake pedal (1) is depressed, the operating
force is transmitted to spool (3) through rod (2) and
spring (4). When spool (3) goes down, drain port a
is closed, and the oil from the pump and accumulator
flows from port A to port C and actuates the rear
brake cylinders.
Lower portion
l When brake pedal (1) is depressed, the operating
force is transmitted to spool (3) through rod (2) and
spring (4). When spool (3) goes down, spool (5) is
also pushed down by plunger (6). When this
Frompumpl +&
happens, drain port b is closed, and the oil from the LL-----6
pump and accumulator flows from port B to port D
and actuates the front brake cylinders.
Accumulator Gi LI
From
P”Z
From
pump
IO-80
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION BRAKE VALVE
Lower portion
l When spool (3) in the upper portion moves up and
the circuit between port A and port C is shut off, oil
also fills the front brake cylinder at the same time, so
the pressure in the circuit between port B and port D
rises. The oil entering port J from orifice f of spool
(5) pushes up spool (5) by the same amount that
spool (3) moves, and shuts off port B and port D.
Drain port b is closed, so the oil entering the brake
cylinder is held, and the brake is applied.
l The pressure in the space in the upper portion is
balanced with the operating force of the pedal, and
the pressure in the space in the lower portion is
balanced with the pressure in the space in the upper Accumulator IU
portion. When spools (3) and (5) move to the end of
their stroke, the circuits between ports A and C and
between ports B and D are fully opened, so the From pum
pressure in the space in the upper and lower
portions and the pressure in the left and right brake
cylinders is the same as the pressure from the
pump. From pump
Therefore, up to the point where the piston moves to
the end of its stroke, the effect of the brake can be
adjusted by the amount that the pedal is depressed.
IO-81
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION BRAKE VALVE
Lower portion
l When the pedal is released, spool (3) in the upper
portion moves up. At the same time, the back
pressure from the brake cylinder and the force of the
spool return spring move spool (3) up. Drain port b To rear brake
is opened and the oil from the brake cylinder flows to cylinder
From pump
the hydraulic tank return circuit to release the front Accumulator
brake. To front brake
cylinder
From pump
SLWOO5l4
IO-82
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ACCUMULATOR CHARGE VALVE
ACC
PP
T A
D SDWO0l-M
IO-83
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ACCUMULATOR CHARGE VALVE
A-A B-B ii
c-c D-D
1. Valve body
2. Safety relief valve (R3)
E-E
3. Relief valve (RI)
4. PPC relief valve (R2)
5. Relief valve (HI)
SDWOOl15
IO-84
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ACCUMULATOR CHARGE VALVE
Operation
1. When no oil is being supplied to accumulator (cut-out
condition)
1) Cut-in condition
. When the pressure at port B is lower than the set
RI 15 t&3
pressure of the relief valve (Rl), piston (8) is pushed
back down by spring (5). Valve seat (7) and poppet (6)
are brought into tight contact, and port C and port T are
shut off.
. The spring chamber at the right end of spool
(15) is also shut off from port T, so the pressure rises,
and the pressure at port P also rises in the same way.
. When the pressure at port P goes above the pressure at
port B (accumulator pressure), the supply of oil to the 16
accumulator starts immediately. In this case, it is decided
by the size (area) of orifice (17) and the pressure
difference (equivalent to the load on spring (14))
generated on both sides of the orifice. A fixed amount is
supplied regardless of the engine speed, and the
remaining oil flows to port A.
IO-85
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ACCUMULATOR CHARGE VALVE
P
SDWOOHS
1O-86
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ACCUMULATOR (FOR BRAKE)
1. Valve
2. Top cover
3. Cylinder
4. Piston
SLWOO5ls
Function
l The accumulator is installed between the charge
valve and the brake valve. It is charged with Specifications
nitrogen gas between cylinder (3) and free piston Gas used: Nitrogen gas
(4) and uses the compressibility of the gas to absorb Charge amount: 3000 cc
the pulse of the hydraulic pump or to maintain the Charging pressure: 3.4 f 0.15 MPa
braking force and to make it possible to operate the (35 + 1.5 kg/cm2) (at 5OOC)
machine if the engine should stop.
IO-87
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ACCUMULATOR (FOR BRAKE)
1. Top cover
2. Piston
3. Cylinder
4. End cover
5. Plug
SAW00516
Function Specifications
9 The accumulator is installed between the brake valve Gas used: Nitrogen gas
and brake cylinder. Nitrogen gas is injected between Charge amount : 45 cc
cylinder (3) and free piston (2), and its compression is Charging pressure: 0.3 f 0.05 MPa
used to maintain braking force operability when the (3 f 0.5 kg/c m2) (at 5OOC)
engine is stopped.
1O-88
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION BRAKE
BRAKE
FRONT BRAKE
1 2 3 4 5 6
Outline
. The front brake have a wet-type multi-disc structure, l Linings are provided on both sides of disc
and consist of piston (2) inner ring (3), disc (4), (4). The disc is incorporated between inner ring (3)
outer ring (5) and spring (9). and outer ring (5) and is coupled by the sun gear
l The brake cylinder consists of differential housing (1) shafts spline.
and bearing carrier (IO), and incorporates piston (2).
Inner ring (3) and outer ring (5) are coupled by the
brake housing (8) spline.
1O-89
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION BRAKE
REAR BRAKE
Outline
l The rear brake is a wet type, single disc brake, and l Disc (4) has a lining installed to both sides, and is
consists of piston (2), disc (4), outer ring (5), and assembled between piston (2) and outer ring (5). It
spring (3). is mated by the spline of sun gear shaft (7).
. The brake cylinder consists of differential housing (1)
and bearing carrier (8) and piston (2) is assembled
in it.
Piston (2) is also mated at the notched portion of
differential housing (1). Outer ring
(5) is secured by a pin to axle housing (6).
1O-90
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION BRAKE
5 a 4 3 2
When the brakes are released
l When the oil pressure is released, piston (2) returns
to its original position by the return force of spring
(8), a gap is produced between inner ring (3) and
outer ring (5), and disc (4) is freed. /
The linings attached to disc (4) are provided with
latticed grooves.
When the disc is turning, oil flows in these grooves,
cooling the linings.
SAW00519
1o-91
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION PARKING BRAKE CONTROL
‘6
Outline
l The parking brake is a wet-type multiple-disc brake l When the parking brake is applied, the neutralizer
built into the transmission. It is installed to the output relay shuts off the electric current to the transmission
shaft bearing, and uses the pushing force of a spring solenoid valve and keeps the transmission at
to apply the brake mechanically and hydraulic power neutral.
to release the brake. . Emergency release switch (2) for the parking brake
. When parking brake switch (1) installed in the is installed for use when moving the machine if the
operator’s compartment is switched ON, parking machine has stopped (the parking brake is
brake solenoid valve (3) installed to transmission automatically applied) because of trouble in the
control valve (4) shuts off the oil pressure and engine or drive system.
applies the parking brake. When the parking brake
switch is turned OFF, the oil pressure in the cylinder
releases the parking brake.
1o-92
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION PARKING BRAKE
PARKING BRAKE
1o-93
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION PARKING BRAKE SOLENOID VALVE
1. Coil
2. Valve assembly
3. Body
A. IN port
B. OUT port
sLwoo522
Function Operation
. This solenoid valve is controlled by the parking brake l Parking brake applied
switch in the operator’s compartment and acts to When the parking brake switch in the operator’s
switch the flow of oil to the parking brake. compartment is turned ON, the solenoid valve is
turned OFF (electric current is cut), and the oil in the
pilot circuit from the transmission pump flows from
the IN port to the OUT port and opens the drain
circuit.
1o-94
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION PARKING BRAKE VALVE
1o-95
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION PARKING BRAKE EMERGENCY RELEASE SOLENOID VALVE
1. Valve assembly
2. Solenoid valve
A: To parking brake
B: From parking brake valve
C: From pilot circuit
T: Drain
P: From brake (accumulator circuit)
,
B A T P
SLWO0525
Function
. The emergency release solenoid valve is installed To paking From paking
From pilot circuit brake brake valve
between the transmission and the transmission
control valve. If the engine fails, and no oil pressure
is supplied from the transmission pump, it is possible
to actuate the solenoid for the parking brake release
switch in the operators compartment. This allows 2
the accumulator charge pressure in the brake circuit
to flow to the parking brake cylinder.
1O-96
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION HYDRAULIC PIPING
HYDRAULIC PIPING
4 \
1O-98
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION HYDRAULIC PIPING
HYDRAULIC PIPING
1. Bucket cylinder
2. Steering valve
3. Hydraulic tank
4. PPC valve
5. Hydraulic pump
6. Oil cooler
7. Accumulator
8. Accumulator charge valve
9. Boom cylinder
10. Cut-off valve
11. Main control valve
Outline
The hydraulic system consists of work equipment
circuit and the steering circuit. The work equipment
circuit controls the actuation of in the bucket and
attachments.
The oil in hydraulic tank (3) is sent to main control
valve (11) by hydraulic pump (5). If the spools for the
bucket and boom in the main control valve are at the
HOLD position, the oil flows to the drain circuit of the
main control valve, is filtered by the filter inside the
hydraulic tank (3) and then returns to the tank.
When the work equipment control levers are operated,
the PPC valve bucket spool or boom spool is actuated,
and the spools of the main control valve (11) are
actuated by hydraulic pressure to send the oil from the
main control valve to boom cylinder (9) or bucket
cylinder (1) to operate the boom or bucket.
Control of the maximum pressure in the hydraulic
circuit is carried out by the relief valve inside the main
control valve. A safety valve (with suction) is installed
in the bucket cylinder circuit to protect the circuit.
Accumulator (7) is installed in the PPC pilot circuit, and
makes it possible to lower the boom to the ground
even when the engine has stopped.
Hydraulic tank (3) is a pressurized sealed type and has
a breather equipped with a relief valve. This makes it
possible to pressurize the inside of the tank and also to
prevent any negative pressure, thereby preventing any
cavitation of the pump.
1o-99
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION WORK EQUIPMENT LEVER LINKAGE
f-’ -
i-l
8
I I 7 9 10 SBWO0742
IO-107
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION HYDRAULIC TANK
HYDRAULIC TANK
1. .Hydraulic tank
2. Sight gauge
3. Oil filler
4. Filter bypass valve
5. Breather
6. Oil filter
Outline l Oil filter (6) is Of a type which filters all the oil in the
l The oil sent to the cylinders from the hydraulic tank circuit. If the oil filter is clogged, the filter bypass
via the pump and through the work equipment valve is activated, preventing the oil from returning
control valve merges with the oil of the various parts directly to the tank and causing damage to the oil
in the return circuit. Some of this oil is cooled by the filter. In addition, the filter bypass valve is also
oil cooler, flows into the tank, is filtered by oil filter activated when a vacuum is generated in the circuit.
(6), and returns to hydraulic tank (1).
IO-108
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION HYDRAULIC TANK
BREATHER
1O-l09
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION PPC VALVE
PPC VALVE
P2 P4
IO-I 10
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION PPC VALVE
‘9
B-B A-A
D-D
SEW00143
1. Bolt
2. Piston
3. Plate
4. Collar
5. Retainer
6. Centering spring
7. Metering spring
6. Valve
9. Body
10-111
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION PPC VALVE
Charge valve
I I /’
Checkvalve
Function
l The oil from the pump enters port P. The circuit is
closed by spool (8), so the oil is drained from relief
valve (1).
At the same time, the oil at port PA1 of the main
control valve is drained from port f of spool (8).
In addition, the oil at port PBI is drained from port f
of spool (8).
IO-112
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION PPC VALVE
Operation
1. Control lever at “hold’ (Fig. 1)
Ports PAI, P4, PBI and PI are connected to drain
chamber D through fine control hole
(f) in valve (8).
IO-113
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION PPC VALVE
(Fig. 3)
- y--J
PBl
t
Control valve
1
(Fig. 4) sEwool48
IO-114
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION PPC RELIEF VALVE
1. Main valve
2. Spring
3. Valve seat
4. Pilot poppet
5. Spring
6. Screw
i 2 3 4 5 6
SDWOOUS
Function
l The PPC relief valve is between the PPC, brake A 1 c B3 4
pump and the PPC valve. When the PPC pump is
not being actuated, or when any abnormal pressure
is generated, the oil sent from the pump is relieved
from this valve to prevent any damage to the pump
or circuit.
Operation
The relief valve is installed to the charge valve. Port
A is connected to the pump circuit and port C is
connected to the drain circuit.
The oil passes through the orifice in main valve (1) I
and fills port B.
In addition, pilot poppet (4) is seated in valve seat
(3). A c 1 B
When the pressure at port A and port B reaches the
set pressure, pilot poppet (4) opens and the oil
pressure at port B escapes from port D to port C to
lower the pressure at port B.
When the pressure at port B goes down, a difference
in pressure is generated at ports A and B by the
orifice of main valve (1). Main valve (1) is opened by
the pressure at port A and the oil at port A is drained
to port C to relieve the circuit.
SDWDDl!%
IO-I15
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ACCUMLATOR (FOR PPC VALVE)
1. Gas plug
2. Shell
3. Poppet
4. Holder
5. Bladder
6. Oil port
Function
l The accumulator is installed between the hydraulic
pump and the PPC valve. Even if the engine stops
when the boom is raised, it is possible to lower the
boom and bucket under their own weight by using
the pressure of the nitrogen gas compressed inside
the accumulator to send the pilot oil pressure to the
main control valve to actuate it.
Operation
. After the engine stops, if the PPC valve is at hold,
chamber A inside the bladder is compressed by the
oil pressure in chamber B.
l When the PPC valve is operated, the oil pressure in
chamber 6 goes below 2.9 MPa (30 kg/cm*). When
this happens, the bladder is expanded by the
pressure of the nitrogen gas in chamber A, and the
oil inside chamber B is used as the pilot pressure to
actuate the main control valve.
IO-116
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN CONTROL VALVE
SAWOOS27
IO-118
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN CONTROL VALVE
D-D
A-A B-B
G-G
IO-I19
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN CONTROL VALVE
3-SPOOL
A. From switch pump (via steering valve) I. From work equipment pump
B. To attachment cylinder J. From attachment PPC valve
C. To bucket cylinder rod side K. From PPC valve port PI
D. To boom cylinder rod side L. From PPC valve port P3
E. Drain port (to tank) M. From attachment PPC valve
P. To boom cylinder bottom side N. From PPC valve port P4
G. To bucket cylinder bottom side 0. From PPC valve port P2
H. To attachment cylinder
IO-120
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN CONTROL VALVE
D-D
B-B
A-A
.I0 IO
.I1
G-G
-
'IO
E-E
F-F H-H
IO-121
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN CONTROL VALVE
RELIEF VALVE
1. Main valve
2. Valve seat
3. Pilot poppet
4. Spring
5. Adjustment screw
sw00541
Function
The relief valve is installed to the inlet portion of the
main control valve. If the oil goes above the set
pressure, the relief valve drains the oil to the tank to
set the maximum pressure for the work equipment
circuit, and to protect the circuit.
Operation
Port A is connected to the pump circuit and port C is
connected to the drain circuit. The oil passes
through the orifice in main valve (I), and fills port B.
Pilot poppet (3) is seated in valve seat (2).
If the pressure inside ports A and B reaches the set C D 34
pressure of pilot poppet spring (4) pilot poppet (3)
opens and the oil pressure at port B escapes from
port D to port C, so the pressure at port B drops.
When the pressure at port B drops, a difference in
pressure between ports A and B is created by the
orifice of main valve (1). The main valve is pushed
open and the oil at port A passes through port C,
and the abnormal pressure is released to the drain
circuit.
The set pressure can be changed by adjusting the
tension of pilot poppet spring (4). To change the set
pressure, remove the cap nut, loosen the locknut,
then turn adjustment screw (5) to adjust the set
pressure as follows.
TIGHTEN to INCREASE pressure
LOOSEN to DECREASE pressure
IO-122
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN CONTROL VALVE
Function
. The safety valve is in the bucket cylinder circuit
inside the main control valve. If any abnormal
pressure is generated by any shock to the cylinder
when the main control valve is at the neutral position,
this valve relieves the abnormal pressure to prevent
damage to the cylinder.
Operation
Operation as safety valve A2 B C 3 D
. Port A is connected to the cylinder circuit and port B
is connected to the drain circuit. The oil pressure at
port A is sent to port D from the hole in pilot piston
(3). It is also sent to port C by the orifice formed
from main valve (2) and pilot piston (3).
Pilot piston (3) is secured to the safety valve, and the
size of the cross-sectional surface (cross-sectional
area) has the following relationship: d2 > d2 > dl d3
> d4.
. If abnormal pressure is created at port A, suction
valve (1) is not actuated because of relationship d2
> dl >, but relationship between port A and port C is
d3 > d4, so main valve (2) receives oil pressure
equivalent to the difference between the areas of d3
and d4. If the oil pressure reaches the force (set
pressure) of main valve spring (4) main valve (2) is
actuated, and the oil from port A flows to port B.
IO-123
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN CONTROL VALVE
SUCTION VALVE
1. Main poppet
2. Sleeve
3. Spring
Function
This valve acts to prevent any negative pressure from
forming in the circuit.
Operation
If any negative pressure is generated at port A (boom
cylinder rod end) (when a pressure lower than tank
circuit port B is generated), main poppet (1) is opened
because of the difference in area between dl and d2, dl d2
and oil flows from port B at the tank end to port A at
the cylinder port end.
IO-124
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN CONTROL VALVE
0 X
0 X
Operation
1. When the work equipment valve is held
The oil at the switch pump (the oil from the
steering valve) presses up check valve (I),
merges with the oil from the work equipment pump
and flows to the work equipment valve.
aM
Steering pump Switch pump sBwoo744
IO-125
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN CONTROL VALVE
steeringpumpSwitch pump
IO-126
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN CONTROL VALVE
MAIN CONTROL VALVE OPERATION BOOM AND BUCKET SPOOL HOLD POSITION
Accumulator
Operation
. The oil from the switch pump which has passed bypass circuit is open, the oil at port B passes
through the cut-off valve and the work equipment around the spool and returns to the tank from the
pump’s oil enter port A and the maximum pressure drain circuit.
is regulated by relief valve (1). l The oil from the PPC pump enters PPC valve port L,
l Since the bucket spool (2) is at the neutral position, but since the boom and bucket levers are at the
the bypass circuit is open, and the oil at port A neutral position, the oil returns to the tank from the
passes around the spool and flows to port B. The PPC relief valve.
boom spool (3) is also at the neutral position, so the
IO-127
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN CONTROL VALVE
lator
I A.
.I. 1 I M N
J
L J
c
25
From work equipment pump
cut-off
c From switch pump
valve
Operation
. When boom lever (4) is pulled, oil flows from PPC (3) bypass circuit. The bypass circuit is closed by
valve port L to port N and port S. The oil at port T boom spool (3) so the oil pushes open check valve
passes through port M and flows to the drain circuit. (5). The oil from check valve (5) flows to port D and
The oil pressure at port S presses boom spool (3) to the cylinder bottom side.
and sets it to the RAISE position. l The oil on the cylinder rod side enters drain port F
. The oil from the pump passes through the bucket from port E and returns to the tank, causing the
spool (2) bypass circuit and flows to the boom spool boom to raise.
IO-128
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN CONTROL VALVE
Accumulator
c From sw-itchpump
Operation
. When boom lever (4) is pushed, oil flows from PPC boom spool (3), so the oil pushes open check valve
valve port L to port M and port T, and the oil at port (5). The oil from check valve (5) flows to port E and
S flows to the drain circuit. The oil pressure at port to the cylinder rod side.
T pushes boom spool (3) and sets it to the LOWER l The oil on the cylinder bottom side enters drain port
position. F from port D and returns to the tank, causing the
. The oil from the pump passes through the bucket boom to lower.
spool (2) bypass circuit and flows to the boom spool
(3) bypass circuit. The bypass circuit is closed by
IO-129
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN CONTROL VALVE
Accumulator
Operation
l When boom lever (4) is pressed in further from the check valve (5) cannot be pushed open. In addition,
LOWER position (to the FLOAT position), boom boom cylinder raise circuit D and lower circuit E are
spool (3) moves further from the LOWER position both connected to the drain circuit, so the boom
and is set to the FLOAT position. lowers under its own weight.
9 The oil from the pump passes through the bucket l When the bucket is touching the ground, it can move
spool (2) bypass circuit and flows to the boom spool up and down in accordance with the ground surface
(3) bypass circuit. Boom spool (3) causes the oil in contour.
the bypass circuit to flow to the drain circuit, so the
IO-130
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN CONTROL VALVE
(-
Accumulator
>_
*
I
> > >__I
a.
J_ J
From PPC valve
I
I,
IF c Fromswitchpump SLWOOS8
Operation
l When bucket lever (6) is pulled, the oil pressure at l The oil from port A passes from check valve (7)
PPC valve port L is released from port P to port R, through port G and to the bottom side of the bucket
and the oil at port V flows to the drain circuit. The oil cylinder.
pressure at port R sets bucket spool (2) to the TILT . The oil on the bucket cylinder’s rod side flows from
position. port H to drain port F and returns to the tank,
. Since the bypass circuit is closed by bucket spool causing the bucket to tilt.
(2) the oil at port A pushes open check valve (7).
IO-131
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN CONTROL VALVE
Aoxmulator
Operation
l When bucket lever (6) is pushed, the oil pressure at through port H and to the rod side of the bucket
PPC valve port L is released from port Q to port V, cylinder.
and the oil at port R flows to the drain circuit. The oil l The oil on the bucket cylinder’s bottom side flows
pressure at port V sets bucket spool (2) to the DUMP from port G to drain port F and returns to the tank,
position. causing the bucket to dump.
. Since the bypass circuit is closed by bucket spool
(2), the oil at port A pushes open check valve (7).
The oil from port A passes from check valve (7)
IO-132
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION WORK EQUIPMENT LINKAGE
1. Bellcrank 4. Boom
2. Bucket cylinder 5. Bucket link
3. Boom cylinder 6. Bucket
IO-134
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION WORK EQUIPMENT LINKAGE
IO-135
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION BUCKET
BUCKET
A-A
1. Bucket
2. Bolt-on cutting edge (BOC)
3. Plate SIuNQQ740
IO-136
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION BUCKET POSITIONER AND BOOM KICK-OUT
1. Proximity switch
2. Plate
3. Bucket cylinder rod
4. Lever
5. Proximity switch
A-A
1O-l 37
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION BUCKET POSITIONER AND BOOM KICK-OUT
BUCKET POSITIONER
l The bucket positioner is an electrically actuated
system which is used to set the bucket to the desired
angle when the bucket is moved from the DUMP
position to the TILT position. When the bucket
reaches the desired position, the bucket lever is
returned from the TILT position to the HOLD
position, and the bucket is automatically set to the
suitable digging angle.
. Lever (4) is secured to bucket cylinder rod (3) by
bolts. In addition, proximity switch (5) fixed to the
cylinder by bolts.
l When the bucket is moved from the DUMP position
to the TILT position, the bucket cylinder rod moves
to the left, and at the same time, lever (4) also
moves to the left. Proximity switch (5) separates
from lever (4) at the desired position, and the bucket sLwoo564
lever is returned to neutral.
BOOM KICK-OUT
. The boom kick-out is an electrically actuated system. 1
It acts to move the boom lever to the HOLD position
and stop the boom at the desired position before the
boom reaches the maximum height.
. Plate (2) is fixed to the boom. In addition, proximity
switch (1) is fixed to the frame. When the boom is
moved from the LOWER position to the RAISE
position, the boom rises, and when it reaches the
desired position, the proximity switch and lever come
together and the system is actuated to return the
boom lever to the HOLD position.
IO-138
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION BUCKET POSITIONER AND BOOM KICK-OUT
Boom lever
/
Proximity switch
Lights up Goes out
actuation display
IO-140
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION BUCKET POSITIONER AND BOOM KICK-OUT
Cam
A /
u,
3
IO-141
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION BUCKET POSITIONER AND BOOM KICK-OUT
To battery relay
Positioner relay
Bucket lever
Cam
Proximity switch
Lights up Goes out
actuation display
IO-142
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION CAB
CAB
1 2
1. Front glass
2. Front wiper
3. Rear wiper
4. Door
IO-143
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION AIR CONDITIONER
AIR CONDITIONER
AIR CONDITIONER PIPING
7 SBWOO572
1. Vent
2, Air conditioner condenser 5. Hot water inlet port
3. Dry receiver 6. Hot water outlet port
4. Compressor 7. Air conditioner unit
IO-144
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ELECTRIC CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
Alternator
Relays
0
Auto-greasing
controller
Main moni.,. ,r .
\
Parking
NAutral Travel speed
knginespeed) Network wiring
Sensors
1. Fuel level
2. Engine water temperature
3. Torque converter oil temperature
4. Engine watertemperature
5. Engine oil level
6. Brake oil pressure
7. Engine oil pressure
8. Air cleaner clogging sBwoo7!So
Outline
l The machine monitor system uses the sensors and l There are also various switches built into the monitor
other devices installed to various parts of the panel which function to operate the machine.
machine to observe the condition of the machine. It
processes this information swiftly and displays it on * When the optional controller are installed, the main
the monitor panel to inform the operator of the monitor communicates with the controller through the
condition of the machine. network wiring and functions to display the controller
9 The machine monitor system consists of the main failure action code and failure code together with the
monitor, maintenance monitor, sensors, switches, time elapsed since the failure (trouble data display
relays, alarm buzzer, and power source. mode).
l The displays can be broadly divided into the
following: Cautions displayed on the monitors
(abnormalities in the machine where an alarm is
given) and normal conditions which are always
displayed on the instrument panel (pilot lamps and
readings for the gauges, speedometer, and service
meter).
IO-158
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN MONITOR
MAIN MONITOR
46 4D 4E 4A 4D 4B
3A
5C
5D
5A 5E
5B
4H 4F
Outline
. The main motor has a display function for the l A liquid crystal display and LEDs are used for the
speedometer and other gauges and a switching display. The switches are embossed sheet
function to control the electric components and switches.
controllers.
l There is one CPU (Central Processing Unit) installed
internally, and this processes the signals from the
sensors and outputs the display.
IO-159
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN MONITOR
Display
category I Symbol Display item
I
Display range
I
Display method
0
When there is
Check CHECK Check abnormality display on MAINTENANCE MONITOR
maintenance monitor DISPLAY FUNCTION)
Emergency steering
Display flashes
1 u 1 actuated 1 When actuated
Display lights up
Buzzer sounds when parking
Parking brake When operated brake is applied and shift lever
is not at N
IO-160
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN MONITOR
IO-161
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAIN MONITOR
Method of switching to With engine stopped and starting All switch displays (LEDs) go out, and failure
trouble data display switch turned ON, press 2nd switch code is displayed on speedomete display and
mode from top on left side of main monitor time elapsed since failure is displayed on
(switch below emergency steering failure action code display.
display) and working lamp (front) (1) Failure code is a two-digit display given in
switch simultaneously for at least 5 numbers or letters. The display for the
seconds. failure now occurring flashes and the
display fo past failures lights up.
If there is no failure, CC is displaye (000 is
87
II-0 0
displayed for time elapsed since failure)
(2 The time elapsed since failure is displayed
as a three-digit number to show how long
ago the failure occurred (the oldest failure
0
time is displayed. Any time greater than
0
999H is displayed as 999H).
sDwoo241
(3) A maximum of 9 items are stored in
memory for the failure code.
Method of sending Press working lamp (front) switch Failure code and time elapsed since
failure code failure change to next item.
,Failure code
Time elapsed
since failure
/
Clearing failure code Press working lamp (rear) switch Failure code and time elapsed since failure being
for at least 2 seconds displayed are cleared. Failure code for problem
now occurring (flashing display) cannot be cleared.
Resetting from travel Press 2nd switch from top on left side Changes to normal display
data display mode of main monitor (switch below
emergency steering display) and
working lamp (front) switch
simultaneously for at least 5 seconds,
or start the enaine.
IO-162
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAINTENANCE MONITOR
sLw00591
Outline
l The maintenance monitor has a display function for l The monitor module has a built-in CPU (Central
the caution items and gauges, and switch functions Processing Unit). It processes the signal from the
to control the work equipment controller (if sensors, and carries out the display and output.
equipped). l A liquid crystal display and LEDs are used for the
. The maintenance monitor consists of the monitor display portions. The switches are embossed sheet
module, switch module, service meter, case, and switches.
other mechanisms.
IO-163
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION MAINTENANCE MONITOR
Display
Symbol Display item Display range Display method
category
Engine water level Below low level Displays when engine is running
Display when normal: OFF
Display when abnormal: Flashes
Engine oil pressure Below specified CAUTION lamp flashes
pressure Buzzer sounds
.-__---------------__
Torque converter oil Above 120°C Buzzer sounds if above 130°C
Caution temperature
n+---I
Air cleaner
Service meter
Above specified
negative pressure
0 - 9999.9h
CHECK lamp flashes
M-IRDSPFN
IO-164
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION E.C.S.S.
2. Structure of system
. The E.C.S.S. consists of the following electronic
devices.
1) E.C.S.S controller (M type controller)
2) Input devices: E.C.S.S switch (system switch),
pressure switch (boom cylinder bottom pressure),
travel speed sensor, model selection wiring harness,
communication
speed range selection wiring harness to main monitor
3) Output devices: solenoid valves (relief valve, high Model selection
pressure accumulator, low pressure accumulator) wiring harness
SEW00268
IO-165
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION E.C.S.S.
3. Content of control
In response to the input on the left side of the table
below, the controller carries out the output on the right 0: ON
side to control the system. X: OFF
Input output
OFF __ __ __ -_ X X I X
OFF OFF
A--
Min. 5
2 OFF ON ON 0 0 X
km/h
ON ON
OFF OFF
Min. 5
3 ON OFF ON OFF 0
km/h
ON ON
ON OFF __ __ X
Min. 5
5 __ -_ km/h X X X
[Note 41
Note 1 The E.C.S.S system is switched ON-OFF by Note 3: Input pulse frequency when travel
operating the E.C.S.S switch on the main monitor. speed is 1 km/h
When the system is ON, the E.C.S.S LED display on the
Model Pulse frequency (Hz)
main monitor lights up.
The ON-OFF condition of the system is retained even WA320 54.41
after the engine stops or the starting switch is turned
OFF. The next time that the starting switch is turned ON, WA380 47.70
the system is set to the same condition as before it was
turned OFF. WA420 40.96
(Main monitor function)
Starting switch OFF+ Machine stops
WA450 44.46
+Starting switch ON
When system is ON+ System ON Note 4: If the travel speed exceeds 5 km/h when the
When system is OFF+ System OFF output is OFF, the output is turned ON.
Note 2: Relationship between speed range signal and When the output is ON, the output stays ON until the
shift position travel speed reaches 3 km/h, and when the travel speed
Speed range goes below 3 km/h, the output is turned OFF.
Shift position
H-L Speed Output ON
1st OFF ON
4th ON ON
ON: +24, OFF: OPEN SEW00269
IO-166
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION E.C.S.S.
4. Self-diagnostic function
This system always observes the condition of the
system, and displays the condition of the system (LED
code, see table below) in the controller self-diagnostic
display portion. If there is any abnormality in the
controller itself or in the input or output devices, the
controller carries out troubleshooting of the
abnormality. It turns all the output OFF and displays
the error code (failure code) in the self- diagnostic
display portion and the main monitor.
LED Condition
Content
displav of svstem
04
55
I Idl
Error in solenoid
(high pressure) system
Error
code L d2
Error in solenoid
(low pressure) system I Abnormal
Abnormality in model
d4 selection (non-available
combination is selected)
1) Displays on controller
.
Error code displays [El+ [dxl] (where x is a
numeral from 0 to 4 in the table above) repeatedly
in turn.
. If more than one abnormality occurs at the same
time, all the appropriate error codes are displayed
in turn.
When the starting switch is turned OFF (controller
l
IO-167
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION E.C.S.S.
1. Controller
5. Controller
2. Self-diagnostic display
Input/output signals
CNALl CNAL2 CNAW
Input/
NO. Name of signal --
output
1 I Network (+I I -
)
L ,
I -
3 1 I -
4 1Travel speed sensor (+_) 1 Input
5 c, I I
6
7
8 Power source input (+24V) - 8 Pressure switch Input
9 GND 9 Network (-1
ill
._ 10
11 Solenoid (low pressure) output 11
12 Network C-1 12 12 Travel speed sensor (-) Input
13 13 Travel speed H-L Input 13
14 Travel speed SPEED Input 1A
15 E.C.S.S. SW Input
SDW00270
IO-168
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION SENSORS
SENSORS
FUNCTION
. The sensors are a contact type sensors with one
end grounded to the chassis. The signal from the
sensor inputs directly to the monitor panel, and
when the contacts are closed, the panel judges the
signal to be normal. However, the engine oil
pressure uses a relay to reverse the sensor signal.
Sensor detection
item
Radiator water
1 Contact / ON 1 OFF
level
Engine water
1 Resistance 1 -- 1 --
temperature
Torque converter
1 Resistance 1 -- 1 --
oil temperature
Fuel Resistance -- --
Electro-
Engine speed
magnetic -
Engine oil
Contact OFF ON
pressure
Terminal D CONNECTOR
Terminal C /
I WIRE
Black
PLUG
Terminal A
Red
(Terminal C )
White
(Terminal A )
L08CDOllA
IO-169
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION SENSORS
2
ti
Structureof circuit
i i 3
SBW00605
1. Float Function
2. Sensor l This sensor is installed to the top of the radiator. If
3. Connector the coolant goes below the specified level, the float
goes down and the switch is turned OFF. The
caution lamp and alarm buzzer are also actuated at
the same time to warn of the abnormality.
Circuit structure
1. Thermistor Function
2. Plug l These sensors are installed to the engine cylinder
3. Tube block and transmission case. The change in the
(Black: torque converter oil temperature) temperature changes the resistance of the
4. Wire thermistor, and a signal is sent to the maintenance
5. Connector monitor to display the temperature. If the display on
the maintenance monitor reaches the specified
position, the lamp flashes and the buzzer sounds to
warn of the abnormality.
IO-170
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION SENSORS
,.
@ :
5
*\ \
F E
Y
&
Structure of circuit
SEW00293
1. Connector
2. Float Function
3. Arm l The fuel level sensor is installed to the side face of
4. Body the fuel tank. The float moves up and down as the
5. Spring level of the fuel changes. As the float moves up and
6. Contact down, the arm actuates a variable resistance, and
7. Spacer this sends a signal to the maintenance monitor to
display the fuel level. When the display on the
maintenance monitor reaches the specified level, the
warning lamp flashes.
IO-171
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION SENSORS
___
0
b
1. Magnet Function
2. Terminal l The engine speed sensor is installed to the ring gear
3. Case portion of the flywheel housing. A pulse voltage is
4. Boot generated by the rotation of the gear teeth, and a
5. Connector signal is sent to the monitor panel.
C B A 1 2 3
1. Connector
2. Button
3. Spring Circuit structure
LoBCOOl
Function
. This sensor is installed to the engine block. The
button detects the oil pressure, and when it drop
below the set pressure, the switch turns OFF and the
machine monitor lamp flashes to warn of the
abnormality.
1O-l 72
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ENGINE STARTING CIRCUIT
SOLENOID
relay
_~oAy+bl~~ relav I I ___ ___
Slow-blow fuse
Battery ENGslRcR
Function
l To ensure safety when starting the engine the When lever is set to N (neutral) position, the lever’s
system is equipped with a neutral safety circuit. This neutral contact is closed. At this time current flows
makes it impossible for the engine to start if the to neutral relay terminals.1 and 2 and the coil is
directional lever is not at the N (Neutral) position. excited.
This causes current to flow in the following circuit:
l To protect the starting motor the system is equipped (1) Starting switch terminal C + neutral relay
with a safety relay. terminals 5 and 3 + starter terminal C, and + fuel
This makes it impossible for the starting motor to cutoff solenoid terminal B (pull in coil). This actuates
start if “R” terminal of alternator voltage is over 12 fuel cutoff solenoid, allowing fuel to flow.
+lv. And also when the starting motor “R” terminal The following circuit is formed:
voltage reaches 12 f Iv, the starter will cut-out + battery relay + starter terminal B. The engine
automatically then starts. When the directional lever is at a
position other then N (neutral), circuit (1) is not
formed, so the engine does start.
Operation
l When the starting switch is set to the start position,
voltage flows in the following circuit:
Starting switch terminal BR + battery relay coil +
ground connection.
This closes battery relay switch.
Current also flows in the following circuit:
Starting switch terminal BR + fuel cut off solenoid
terminal A (holding coil).
IO-173
0
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ENGINE STOP CIRCUIT
5A FROM 5A FUSE
CN E03
Alternator A- FUEL
CUTOFF
SOLENOID
Neutral *
relay
Slow-blow fuse
Battery
STARTER SWITCH
Function
l The system is equipped with an electrical fuel cut When electric current flows to the fuel cut solenoid,
device (fuel cutoff solenoid). Which makes it the fuel governor is put in the FREE position by the
possible to START or STOP the engine by turning fuel control linkage.
the starting switch ON or OFF. This improves the Fuel flows to the fuel injection pump and the engine
ease of operation. starts.
1O-l 74
a
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ETHER START CIRCUIT
FROM SA FUSE
CN E03
Alternator
CUTOFF
SOLENOID
CN EM
Directional lever -
IQA m; \
I IsLtartlng I4I
Safety relay
I II
-l--u II w f n
Neutral *
3oA A
-_ _-
sloEPw
Slow-blow fuse
Function
l The ether injection system delivers a 3cc shot of
ether to the engine to aid in cold weather starting.
Operation
l With the lever in N (neutral) turn key to start position.
This completes cranking circuit as described in
engine starting section, and engine begins cranking.
This also completes circuit from start switch “B” to
start switch “R2” applying power to ether start switch.
. Move ether start switch to ON position then release
immediately (Do not hold it at ON position for more
than 5 seconds. This will cause failure of ether start
solenoid) This allows current to flow in the following
circuit. Start switch terminal “R2” to ether start
switch terminal “1” to ether start switch terminal “2”
to ether solenoid “1” to ground. This actuates ether
start solenoid , injecting ether.
IO-175
0
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ELECTRIC TRANSMISSION CONTROL
KidcdownswM
Tmrismissioncut~
sf?lecbr switch
switch s8woo752
Fu ction
1 Selection of F, R, and N positions Using directional lever
-
2 Selection of speed range Using speed lever
-
When traveling in F2, it is possible to shift down to 1st using this
3 Kick-down switch switch without using the speed lever. If directional lever is operated
to R or N, speed range automatically returned to 2nd.
-
4 Transmission cut-off function Transmission is shifted to neutral when left brake is operated
-
It is possible to select whether to actuate or not actuate the
transmission cut-off function. In this way, it is possible to obtain the
5 Transmission cut-off selector function same or greater ease of operation as on conventional loaders with
the left brake when carrying out scooping work or when loading or
unloading the machine from a trailer.
-
To prevent seizure of the parking brake when traveling .with the
6 Neutralizer parking brake applied, the transmission is shifted to neutral when
the parking brake is applied.
-
If the directional lever is not at the N position, the engine will not
7 Neutral safety function start when the starting switch is turned. This prevents the machine
from starting suddenly. (For details, see STARTING CIRCUIT.)
-
When traveling in reverse, the backup lamp lights up and the
8 Warning function
backup horn sounds to warn people in the area.
IO-176
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ELECTRIC TRANSMISSION CONTROL
COMBINATION SWITCH
2 3 9 IO 4 6
Outline
l The directional lever has three positions and the body by three screws. When each lever is operated to
speed lever switch has four positions. As an the desired position, the switch, which is interconnected
individual part, the switch does not have a detent by a shaft, acts to allow electric current to flow to that
mechanism; the detent mechanism is in the circuit only.
combination switch. Each switch is positioned by
two pins, and is secured to the
Stopper used to prevent speed lever from entering 3rd or 4th during
3 Speed lever stopper
operations
4 Turn signal indicators Direction indicator lamps used when turning left or right
6 Lamp switch Switches on clearance lamp, head lamp, parking lamp, etc.
7 Dimmer switch Selects high beam for travel and low beam for passing
Makes both left and right turn signal indicator lamps flash at the
8 Hazard switch
same time
9 Emergency flashing pilot lamp Flashes at the same time as the emergency flashing lamp flashes
IO-177
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ELECTRIC TRANSMISSION CONTROL
Operation
Directional lever (1)and shaft (2) of the speed lever
of the combination switch form one unit with magnet
(3), and magnet (3) also moves together with lever
(1).
Control switch (5) with built-in hole IC (4) is installed
at the bottom of magnet (3) and hole IC (4) is
positioned on the board to match each position.
When directional lever (1) is operated to the F
position, magnet (3) is immediately above hole IC (4)
for the F position of the control switch. The
magnetism from magnet (3) passes through the gap
and case (6) and magnetism is applied to hole IC
(4).
When this happens, hole IC (4) is inside a
magnetism detection circuit, so it detects the
magnetism of magnet (3) and sends the F position
signal to the electric current amplification circuit. In
the electric current amplification circuit, a signal is
output to actuate the transmission.
3Lwoom3
1O-l 78
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION KICK-DOWN, HOLD SWITCH
KICK-DOWN SWITCH
Operation
3. Side cap
4. Wiring harness
IO-179
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION KICK-DOWN ELECTRIC CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
IO-180
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION KICK-DOWN ELECTRIC CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
K&down
CNISS CNL!i8 CNL53 CNL57
Transmission Nwtralizer Stoph-np
switch
cut-dfrebv * rekv w safe
. When the kick-down switch is pressed, electric In this way, if the kick-down switch is pressed when the
current flows from the battery (+) + speed lever 2 + speed lever is at F2, the transmission will shift to Fl. At
FORWARD relay terminal 3 - 4 + kick-down switch the same time, it will be held in Fl by the self-hold
+ kick-down relay terminal 5 - 6 + ground. function of the kick-down relay even when the kick-down
As a result, the kick-down is actuated, and kick-down switch is released. However many times the kick-down
relay terminals 1 and 2 and terminals 3 and 4 are switch is pressed, the transmission will stay in Fl.
closed. A circuit from kick-down relay terminal 1 - 2
+ kick-down relay terminal 5 - 6 + ground is
formed, so the kick-down relay continues to be
actuated even if the kick-down switch is returned.
(Self-hold circuit of kick-down relay)
l When the kick-down relay is actuated and terminals
3 and 4 + are closed, electric current flows from the
battery (+) + kick-down relay terminal 3 - 4 3
solenoid 4 + ground, and solenoid (4) is actuated.
Solenoids (1) and (4) are actuated, so the
transmission is set to Fl.
IO-181
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION KICK-DOWN ELECTRIC CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
When the directional lever is moved to the R l When the directional lever is moved to the R
position, the F terminal contacts are turned OFF, so position, current flows from the battery (+) +
the electric current stops flowing from the battery (+) directional lever R + REVERSE relay terminal 5 - 6
+ directional lever F + FORWARD relay terminal 5 - + ground, so the REVERSE relay is actuated and
6 + ground, and the FORWARD relay is reset. REVERSE terminals 1 and 2 and terminals 3 and 4
FORWARD relay terminals 1 and 2 and terminals 3 are closed.
and 4 are opened, so the electric current stops l As a result, electric current flows from the battery (+)
flowing to the solenoid of the kick-down relay, and REVERSE relay terminal 1 - 2 + solenoid 2 +
the kick-down relay is reset. ground, and solenoid (2) is actuated. Therefore,
In this way, the self-hold circuit of the kickdown relay only solenoid (2) is actuated, and the transmission is
is canceled, and terminals 3 and 4 are opened, so set to the R2 position.
solenoid (4) is no longer actuated. (When the
directional lever is moved to the N position, the
actuation is the same as above and the kick-down
relay is canceled.)
In addition, FORWARD relay terminal 1 and 2 are
opened, so solenoid (1) is no longer actuated.
1O-l 82
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION KICK-DOWN ELECTRIC CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
IO-183
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION KICK-DOWN ELECTRIC CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
1O-l84
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CUT-OFF SWITCH
8 7
1. Case 5. Tube
2. Seal film 6. Connector
3. Disc 7. Cover
4. Vinyl tape 8. Spring
Outline
When the left brake pedal is operated, the switch Specifications
detects the oil pressure in the brake circuit, shuts off Min. 18v
the electric Dower to the solenoid valve circuit for the Voltage
directional ‘clutch, and shifts the transmission to
neutral.
IO-185
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CUT-OFF FUNCTION
I Tmsrnission
cut-off twitch
Transmission
combinationswitch
Outline Operation
. If the transmission cut-off selector switch on the 1. Transmission cut-off selector switch ON
main monitor is turned ON (pilot lamp lights up), the . If the transmission cut-off selector switch is turned
transmission cut-off switch installed to the left brake ON, the transmission cut-off relay solenoid is not
pedal is actuated. When the left brake pedal is excited, so transmission cutoff relay terminals 3 - 5
operated, the brakes are applied, and the are not connected. In this condition, +24V voltage is
transmission is shifted to neutral at the same time. applied through only the transmission cut-off switch
If the transmission cut-off selector switch is set to the to transmission control valve solenoids R and F.
OFF position (pilot lamp goes out), the transmission l When the left brake pedal is depressed, the contacts
is not shifted to neutral even when the brake is of the transmission cut-off switch are opened, so the
operated, so the left brake functions only as a brake voltage to solenoids R and F is shut off. As a result,
in the same way as the right brake. the brakes are applied as normal, and the
transmission is also shifted to neutral at the same
time.
IO-186
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION TRANSMISSION CUT-OFF FUNCTION
Transmission
IO-187
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ELECTRIC PARKING BRAKE CONTROL
sBwoos27
Outline
l The parking brake is a wet-type multiple disc brake 1. Parking brake switch
built into the transmission. When an electric current 2. Parking brake emergency release switch
flows to the parking brake valve (solenoid valve), the 3. Parking brake safety relay
oil pressure from the transmission pump is applied to 4. Parking brake emergency release relay
the parking brake cylinder and the parking brake is 5. Neutralizer relay
released. 6. Parking brake solenoid valve
l When the electric current is cut, the oil pressure from 7. Transmission control valve
the transmission pump is shut off, and the oil 8. Accumulator
pressure inside the parking brake cylinder passes 9. Parking brake emergency release valve
through the parking brake valve and is drained. The 10. Transmission (built-in parking brake)
parking brake is then applied by the force of the
brake spring.
IO-188
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ELECTRIC PARKING BRAKE CONTROL
Function
1. Applying and releasing parking brake The parking 6. Parking brake emergency release solenoid valve
brake is applied or released by using the parking If the supply of pressure oil from the transmission
brake switch (combination switch). pump should stop because of some failure, it is
possible to actuate the emergency relief solenoid
2. Automatic parking brake valve with the parking brake emergency release
When the engine stops (when the starting switch is switch in the operators compartment. This sends
OFF), the parking brake is automatically applied to the accumulator charge pressure in the brake piping
prevent the machine from running away when the to the parking brake cylinder to release the parking
operator is away from his seat. brake.
3. Emergency brake
If the pressure in the oil pump should drop because
of damage to the hydraulic circuit and the braking
force can not be ensured, the parking brake is
applied automatically to act as an emergency brake.
5 Neutralizer
The parking brake may seize if the machine is driven
with the parking brake still applied. To prevent this
problem, the caution lamp lights up and the alarm
buzzer sounds to warn the operator of the mistaken
operation. In addition to this, when the parking brake
is applied, the transmission is forcibly shifted to
neutral to make it impossible to drive the machine.
However, the braking distance will become longer if
the transmission is shifted to neutral when the
emergency brake is applied. It may also be
necessary to move the machine if it stops in places
where it is prohibited to stop (such as on railway
crossings). To overcome this, the circuit is designed
so that the transmission is not shifted to neutral
when the emergency brake is applied.
IO-189
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ELECTRIC PARKING BRAKE CONTROL
Connection table
3 1
IO-190
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ELECTRIC PARKING BRAKE CONTROL
f-1
; L-_7 :
Relay actuation table
ml
6
3 5
1
1. Case
2 2. Base
Internal connection diagram
sEwooa2l
IO-191
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ELECTRIC PARKING BRAKE CONTROL
OPERATION
1. Starting switch OFF
Battery relay
1O-l92
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ELECTRIC PARKING BRAKE CONTROL
2. Starting switch ON
2-I When parking brake switch is ON (actuated) before starting is turned ON
The electric current flows in circuit (1) from the l In this condition, electric current does not flow to the
battery (+) + starting switch + battery relay coil + parking brake solenoid valve, so the parking brake is
ground, so the battery relay is closed. When this actuated.
happens, electric current flows in circuit (2) from the l In addition, in this condition, neutralizer relay
battery(+) + battery relay + parking brake switch terminals 3 and 5 are open, so electric current does
terminal 1 - 3 + parking brake safety relay terminal not flow to the transmission directional circuit, and
1 - 2 + ground. In this way, the parking safety relay the transmission is shifted to neutral.
is actuated and safety relay terminals 3 - 5 are
closed.
When this happens, circuit (3) is formed from the
battery (+) + battery relay + parking safety relay
terminal 5 - 3 + parking safety relay terminal 1 - 2 +
ground. From this point, the parking safety relay is
in the condition of circuit (3) until the starting switch
is turned OFF.
IO-193
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ELECTRIC PARKING BRAKE CONTROL
2-2 When parking brake switch is OFF(actuated) before starting switch is turned ON
312352
+
To transmission speed circuit
To transmission directional circuit
kwtalled to accumulator)
Parking
brake
solenoid
9 TBwoo632
l Electric current flows in circuit from the battery (+) l In addition, the electric current does not flow to the
+ starting switch + battery relay coil + ground, so transmission directional circuit, so the machine does
the battery relay is closed. However, in this case, not move.
the parking brake switch is OFF (released), so the
parking safety relay is not actuated. For this reason,
the electric current does not flow to the parking
brake solenoid valve, so after the automatic parking
brake is applied, the parking brake is not released
automatically even when the starting switch is turned
ON.
IO-194
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ELECTRIC PARKING BRAKE CONTROL
lBWOOS33
l If the parking brake switch is turned from ON (2)This circuit is formed from the emergency brake
(actuated) to OFF (released), the circuit for terminals switch + parking brake solenoid valve + ground, and the
2 and 3 of the parking brake switch is connected, parking brake is released.
and the parking brake safety relay is also actuated. (3)This circuit is formed from the battery(+) + battery
For this reason, electric current flows in circuit (1) relay + neutralizer relay terminal 3 - 5 + transmission
from the battery (+) + battery relay + parking brake directional circuit, so when the directional lever is
safety relay + parking brake switch, and then flows operated, the machine will move.
to circuits (2) and (3) given below.
IO-195
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ELECTRIC PARKING BRAKE CONTROL
4
1235
Starting witch
- I I + Alternator
Bf4 terminal R
1
I Parking
To transmission directional circuit brake
solenoid
+ w w valve h
To transmission speed circuit Emergency brake switch
(installed to accumulator)
lBwooa34
l If the parking brake switch is turned ON (applied) . In addition, at the same time, the neutralizer relay is
after carrying out operations with the parking brake reset, so the circuit between terminals 3 and 5 is
switch OFF (released), the circuit in the diagram opened, and no electricity flows to the transmission
above is formed. directional circuit, so the transmission is shifted to
. Electric current does not flow to the parking brake neutral. This kind of neutralizer relay shuts off the
solenoid valve, so the oil pressure from the electric current going to the transmission solenoid
transmission pump to the parking brake cylinder is valve when the parking brake is applied and shifts
shut off. At the same time, the oil pressure inside the transmission to neutral to prevent seizure of the
the parking brake cylinder passes through the parking brake if the operator should drive the
parking brake valve and is drained, so the parking machine with the parking brake still applied.
brake is applied by the force of the spring.
IO-196
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ELECTRIC PARKING BRAKE CONTROL
Battery relay
Startingswitch
t valve
To transmission speed circuit Emergency brake switch
(installed & accumulator)
lBwooe35
Operation
. If the oil pressure in the main brake line drops, the . For this reason, electric current flows to the
emergency brake switch installed to the accumulator transmission directional circuit, and it is possible to
is opened. engage the transmission clutch. In this way, it is
. For this reason, the electric current stops flowing to possible to use the engine brake when the
the parking brake solenoid valve, so the oil pressure emergency brake is applied, so the braking distance
inside the parking brake cylinder is drained and the becomes shorter. At the same time, if the
parking brake is applied. However, in this case, the emergency brake has been applied and it is
condition is different from the case where the parking necessary to move the machine (for example, if the
brake switch is ON (applied), because there is emergency brake is applied when the machine is on
electric current flowing to the neutralizer relay coil. a railway crossing), it is possible to move the
machine by operating the transmission lever.
IO-197
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ELECTRIC PARKING BRAKE CONTROL
CNL 1
SollICE!
1
Startingswitch
‘L
6irake ACC
low pressure
w
switch
Pakin’
releas
5”
brakeemergency
soknoid valve
.sLwoo636
Operation
l If the machine should stop because of engine l The oil pressure stored in the accumulator in the
trouble, the oil pressure from the transmission pump main brake line then flows to the parking brake
to the parking brake cylinder is shut off and the cylinder to release the parking brake.
parking brake is applied. When this happens, the oil l The emergency release switch should normally be
pressure in the main brake line is stored in the kept at the OFF position and should be returned to
accumulator. When the emergency release switch the OFF position after the emergency release.
is turned on (released), the buzzer sounds, and at
the same time, electric current flows to the
emergency parking brake release solenoid valve.
IO-198
STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION ELECTRIC PARKING BRAKE CONTROL
Outline
l When the parking brake is applied, this relay keeps
the transmission at neutral to prevent dragging of the
parking brake due to mistaken operation.
t Tobetten/
power source
SLWOO637
Operation
1. When the parking brake is actuated (ON), electric 3. When the engine is started with the parking brake
current flows from the battery relay + parking brake switch OFF (released), the circuit in Item 1 is not
switch terminal 1 - 3 + parking brake safety relay formed, so it is necessary to turn the parking brake
terminal 1 + ground. For this reason, the safety switch ON to form the circuit.
relay coil is actuated, terminals 3 and 5 of the safety
relay are connected, and this circuit is formed.
IO-199
20 STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION
Standard value table for engine ................. 20- 2 Measuring clearance between tire and wheel . . . . 20-26
Standard value table for chassis ................ 20- 3 Testing and adjusting steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . 20-27
Standard value table for electrical system ......... 20- 7 Measuring steering oil pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-29
Service tools for testing, adjusting & troubleshooting Measuring operating force and
.......................................... 20-I 1 travel of brake pedal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... . 20-31
Measuring engine speed ..................... 20-12 Measuring brake performance ............ ... . 20-32
Measuring intake manifold pressure ............. 20-12 Testing brake oil pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... . 20-33
Measuring intake air restriction ................. 20-12 Testing for brake disc wear ______. . . . . . . . ... . 20-34
Measuring engine lubrication oil pressure ........ 20-13 Bleeding air from brake system __. . . . . . . . . . __ . 20-35
Measuring fuel filter inlet restriction ............. 20-13 Measuring parking brake performance . . . . . . . _. . 20-36
Measuring blow-by pressure .................. 20-13 Manual release method for parking brake . . . ... . 20-37
Measuring exhaust back pressure .............. 20-14 Testing wear of parking brake disc . . . . . . . . . ... . 20-38
Measuring exhaust gas color .................. 20-15 Measuring work equipment control lever . . . . . _. . 20-39
Measuring coolant temperature ................ 20-16 Measuring work equipment hydraulic pressure .. . 20-41
Measuring and adjusting valve clearance ........ 20-16 Measuring PPC valve pressure . . . _ . . . . _. . ... . 20-43
Measuring wastegate actuator calibration ........ 20-16 Measuring work equipment .............. . _. . 20-45
Measuring stall speeds ....................... 20-17 Testing and adjusting bucket positioner . . . . . ... . 20-47
Measuring accelerator pedal .................. 20-19 Testing and adjusting boom kick-out . . . . . . ... . 20-48
Measuring operating force & travel of directional speed Adjusting main monitor (speedometer module) .. . 20-50
levers .................................... 20-21
Measuring torque converter, transmission, & parking brake
oil pressure ................................ 20-22
Method of operating emergency manual spool .... 20-24
* When using the standard value tables to make judgement for testing and adjusting or troubleshooting, the following
precautions are necessary.
1. The standard value for a new machine given in the table is the value used when shipping the machine from the factory
and is given for reference. It is used as a guideline for judging the progress of wear after the machine has been operated,
and as a reference value when carrying out repairs.
2. The service limit value given in the tables is the estimated value for the shipped machine based on the results of various
tests. It is used for reference together with the state of repair and the history of operation to judge if there is a failure.
3. These standard values are not the standards used in dealing with claims.
A When carrying out work together with other workers, always use signals and do not let unauthorized
machine.
people near the
A When checking the coolant level, always wait for the coolant to cool down. If the radiator cap is removed when the
coolant is still hot, the coolant will spurt out and cause burns.
A Be careful not to get caught in the fan, fan belt or other rotating parts.
20-I
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING STANDARD VALUE TABLE FOR ENGINE
Coolant temperature in
operating range:
Blow-by pressure . Service Tool orifice size: mm H,O 100 460
7.67 mm
l At T.C. stall and W.O.T.
Maximum operating
Coolant temperature “C 100 100
temperature
Engine cold:
Valve clearance Intake valves mm 0.30 0.30
Exhaust valves 0.61 0.61
20-Z
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING STANDARD VALUE TABLE FOR CHASSIS
Operating force
011
Operating angle
a2
./
13.7 (1.4)
13.7 (1.4)
40f 10 40 f 20
Travel mm
40* 10 40 + 20
40f 10 40 f 20
Travel mm 40f 10 40 * 20
3rd t) 4th
I I 40+ 10 I 40 f 20
Priority
pressure si
0.33; ; ;.;8
0.34 +j$ (3.5 :;:I: 1
MPa ( )
:g/cm*) 0.98 + 0:l
ill-l + 11
0.98+$ (lo+_: 1
20-3
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING STANDARD VALUE TABLE FOR CHASSIS
Cats
Item Measurement conditions Unii Standard value
w
l Tire inflation pressure:
A Specified pressure Max. 2.5
Fitting of wheel
mm Max. 4.5
2- 12
lock ring L TEi’WOO3 TEWWKM
l Engine stopped
Play l Maf;,ho’n”efacing straight mm 20 f 20 60
Play 5 f 0.5 -
ai deg. 45 -
Operating angle
a2 15* 1
I l
l
Flat, horizontal, straight, dry
oaved road surface
Speed when applying brake
20 knvh, braking delay: 0.1 sec.
Performance m Max. 5 Max. 5
l Brake pedal operating force:
265Nl27kal
l Tire inflation pressure: --
Specified pressure
20-4
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING STANDARD VALUE TABLE FOR CHASSIS
RAKE + HOLD
HOLD + LOWER
Boom
$
LOWER + HOLD
+z
z LOWER+ FLOAT
z (Max. 3.5) (5.3)
2
x Max. 14.7 22.6
FLOAT + HOLD
3 (Max. 1.5) (2.3)
k
Boom HOLD + LOWER
5
G HOLD + FLOAT mm
$
: Boom lowering time
l Hydraulic oil
i temperature: 45 - 55°C
i Bucket dumping time l Engine speed: High idling Sec. 1.2 + 0.3 I 1.8
; - l Steering valve: Neutral
)- l No load
z Bucket At full stroke 1.8 + 0.3 I 2.7
tilting
i.
time Bucket horizontal
20-5
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING STANDARD VALUE TABLE FOR CHASSIS
Cate- Per-ais$ble
Item Measurement conditions Unit Standard value
WY
C l Hydraulic oil
w ‘C Retraction of boom temperature: 45 - 55°C
cylinder rod l Leave for 5 minutes after Max. 15.0 20
ri TJ
stopping engine then mm -
S.$ $ measure for next 15
o- Retraction of bucket minutes
a-E cylinder rod Max. 15.0 20
l Bucket empty, boom,
I
bucket
E Clearance of bucket horizontal
l No load 3-7 -
‘Es positioner switch
.--’ l Hydraulic oil
3 2 Clearance of boom temperature: 45 - 55°C mm
II 3-7 -
kick-out switch
20-6
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING STANDARD VALUE TABLE FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
CNR07 2) CNR07
Fuel level sensor
(male) disconnected
20-7
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING STANDARD VALUE TABLE FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
20-8
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING STANDARD VALUE TABLE FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
1 Between @and@
I
1 7.5 to 9.5 R
1) Starting switch
OFF
II 2) Connector
fm
iii 1-$j2 1 Between
disconnected
Dumping solenoid
:::lzy
t
=
g
E Normal if within the following range:
E Boom angle
g potentiometer :::lz;
3
$
Normal if within the following range:
Bucket angle
potentiometer FiEy
20-9
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING STANDARD VALUE TABLE FOR ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
-
SY Name of Connect01 nmectia
Judgment table
Measurement
tel comoonent No. conditions
-
I) g;-ting switch
Relief solenoid
CNAFC
(male) I Between 0 and @ 20 to 40 s2
-1 2) CNAF4
disconnected
I) Starting switch
Between 0 and @ 20 to 40 a OFF
High pressure CNAF5 2) CNAF5
solenoid (male) disconnected
Normal if as follows:
1) $aFrting switch
Low pressure
solenoid
CNAFG
(male)
I Between @ and @ 20 to 40 R
I 2) CNAFG
disconnected
Normal if as follows:
1) gfFtiing switch
CNAF7 2) CNAF7
Pressure switch
(male) disconnected
20-10
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING TOOLS FOR TESTING, AND ADJUSTING AND TROUBLESHOOTING
I
Engine speeds Digital optical tachometer Digital display
L : 60-2000 rpm
R : 60-l 9999 rpm
Fuel filter inlet restriction Vacuum gauge See Engine Shop Manual
Blow-by pressure E Tool, adapter & manometer See Engine Shop Manual
I Discoloration
1 1 1799201-9000 1 Handy smoke detector O-70% with standard color
% x l/IO = Bosch index
Exhaust gas color G-
I 2 Commercially
available I
Smoke meter
Pushing angle -
Pushing force -
Stroke -
20-I 1
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING ENGINE SPEEDS, INTAKE PRESSURE AND RESTRICTION
A When removing or installing the measuring equipment, be careful not to touch any high temperature parts.
1. Install the digital optical tachometer using the instructions supplied with it.
A When measuring engine speeds, be careful not to touch any high temperature parts or rotating parts.
2. Start the engine, and measure the engine speed when it is set to the conditions for measuring.
1) Measuring low idle and high idle speeds.
2) Measure the speed at near the rated speed.
* When measuring speeds for items other than the above, such as torque converter stall, see the
procedure for the item as described in this section.
20-12
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING ENG. OIL PRESS.,FUEL FILTER RESTRICTION& BLOW BY PRESS.
BKPOSSSE
20-13
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING EXHAUST BACK PRESSURE
20-14
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING EXHAUST GAS COLOR
A ful
Gl
When measuring the exhaust gas color, be care-
not to touch the exhaust pipe or any other
high temperature part.
TBwkn15
k Warm up the engine (oil temperature: 60%) be-
fore measuring the exhaust gas color.
1) Fit filter paper in tool GI.
2) Insert the exhaust gas intake port into the
exhaust pipe, accelerate the engine suddenly,
and at the same time operate the handle to
catch the exhaust gas on the filter paper.
3) Remove the filter paper and compare it with
the scale provided to judge the condition.
20-15
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING COOLANT TEMP., ADJUST VALVE, 8sWASTEGATE CALIBRATION
2046
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING STALL SPEEDS
* Measurement conditions
20-I 7
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING STALL SPEEDS
20-18
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING ACCELERATOR PEDAL
* Measurement conditions,
. Engine water temperature: Within green ,range
on engine water temperature gauge
1. Measuring
1) Set push-pull scale K at a position 150 mm
from pedal fulcrum a.
* Put the center of push-pull scale K in
contact with a point 150 mm from the
pedal fulcrum.
2. Testing
1) Stop the engine.
2) Disconnect cable (1) at the bottom of the
accelerator pedal and check that there is no
heaviness in the accelerator -pedal linkage.
3) Connect cable (1) at the bottom of the pedal;
detach cable (2) at the injection pump con-
nection, and check that there is no heavi-
ness in the cable.
m Cable joint nut:
13.7 .f 0.98Nmf1.4.f 0.1 kgm)
1. Measuring
1) Stop the engine.
2. Adjusting
1) Remove the cover at the bottom of the (cab,
and open the inspection cover of the engine
hood.
20-20
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING OPERATING FORCE 8 TRAVEL OF DIRECTION & SPEED LEVERS
k Measurement conditions
. Engine stopped
l Torque converter oil temperature: 60 - 80°C
20-21
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING T/C, TRANS., & PARKING BRAKE OIL PRESSURE
MEASURING TORQUE
CONVERTER, TRANSMISSION,
PARKING BRAKE OIL
PRESSURE
* Measurement conditions
A the
Apply the
tires.
parking brake and put blocks under
Preparatory work
20-22
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING T/C, TRANS., & PARKING BRAKE OIL PRESSURE
Measuring procedure
1. Priority pressure
1) Measuring port (Pl or P5, PTV8) Pl,P5
3. Pilot pressure
1) Measuring port (P3, PT1/8)
2) Start the engine and measure the pressure.
* Remove hose (1) and elbow (2) and at-
tach the hydraulic test kit to nipple (3).
P3
4. Clutch pressure
1) Measuring port (P4, PTV8)
2) Start the engine, set the forward/reverse le-
ver to neutral, and measure the pressure
when the gear shift lever is operated.
20-230
TESTING AND ADJUSTING METHOD OF OPERATING EMERGENCY MANUAL SPOOL
METHOD OF OPERATING
EMERGENCY MANUAL SPOOL
Outline
20-24
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING METHOD OF OPERATING EMERGENCY MANUAL SPOOL
20-25
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING CLEARANCE BETWEEN TIRE AND WHEEL
MEASURING CLEARANCE
BETWEEN TIRE AND WHEEL
Method of measuring
1. Fitting of wheel lock ring
Using feeler gauge, measure dimensions A and
B at four places around the circumference.
TEWOO084
I TEWOO085
20-26
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING TESTING AND ADJUSTING STEERING WHEEL
Measuring procedure
1. Turn the steering wheel lightly clockwise and
counterclockwise two or three times to check
that the steering mechanism is in neutral, then
put a mark “a” on the outer frame of the vehicle
monitor.
* Measurement conditions
Measurement method
20-27
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING TESTING AND ADJUSTING STEERING WHEEL
* Measurement conditions
Measurement method
20-28
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING STEERING OIL PRESSURE
* Measurement conditions
A inside
Loosen the oil filler
the hydraulic
cap to release the pressure
tank, then turn the steering
wheel several times to release the remaining
pressure inside the piping.
20-29
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING METHOD OF ADJUSTING MAIN RELIEF PRESURE
I
METHOD OF ADJUSTING MAIN RELIEF PRES- Rear
SURE
20-30
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING OPERATING FORCE, TRAVEL OF BRAKE PEDAL
MEASURING OPERATING
FORCE, TRAVEL OF BRAKE
PEDAL
* Measurement conditions
Travel of pedal
1. Fit push gauge N to your foot.
* Set the push gauge at a position 150 mm
from the pedal fulcrum.
Pedal play
1. Start the engine.
2. Push the brake pedal lightly by hand, and meas-
ure pedal angle 0~3when the pedal starts to be-
come heavy.
20-3;
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING BRAKE PERFORMANCE
MEASURING BRAKE
PERFORMANCE
* Measurement conditions
. Road surface: Flat, horizontal, dry paved surface
. Travel speed: 20 km/h when brakes are applied
. Delay in applying brakes: 0.1 set
. Tire inflation pressure: Specified pressure
Measurement method
1. Start the engine and move the machine.
I TOW00113
20-32
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING TESTING BRAKE OIL PRESSURE
* Measurement conditions
. Engine water temperature: Within engine water
temperature gauge green range
. Testing pressure: 4.9 MPa (50 kg/cm*)
A Apply the parking brake and chocks the tires.
Measuring procedure
1. Stop the engine.
2. Disconnect brake tube (1) on the side to be meas-
ured.
3. Disconnect union (21, install joint @ and attach
hydraulic test kit C
20-32
TESTING AND ADJUSTING TESTING FOR BRAKE DISC WEAR
* Measurement conditions
. Engine water temperature: Within engine water
temperature gauge green range
a Apply the parking brake and chocks the tires.
Measuring
1. Loosen drain plug (1) and drain the axle oil.
- : Axle oil: 25 !
Axle oil: 25 -!
20-34
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING BLEEDING AIR FROM BRAKE SYSTEM
A_ Apply the
the tires.
parking brake and securely chocks
20-35
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING PARKING BRAKE PERFORMANCE
* Measurement conditions
l Tire inflation pressure: Specified pressure
. Road surface: Flat, dry paved road surface with
slope of l/5 grade (11020’).
. Machine: Operating condition
Measurement method
hill.
20-36
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MANUAL RELEASE METHOD FOR PARKING BRAKE
A Always stop
procedure.
the engine before carrying out this
20-3L
TESTING AND ADJUSTING TESTING WEAR OF PARKING BRAKE DISC
20-38
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING WORK EQUIPMENT CONTROL LEVER
MEASURING WORK
EQUIPMENT CONTROL LEVER
* Measurement conditions
. Engine water temperature: Within green range
on engine water temperature gauge
. Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 - 55°C
. Engine speed: Low idling
Measurement method
1. Operating force of work equipment control le-
ver
Install push-pull scale K to the work equipment
control lever and measure the operating force.
* Install the push-pull scale to the center of
the knob.
J, Operate the control lever at the same speed
as for normal operations, and measure the
minimum value for the force needed to op-
erate the knob.
20-39
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING WORK EQUIPMENT CONTROL LEVER
Adjusting
1. Remove cover (1).
3. Boom lever
Operate the boom lever and adjust the length of
rod (2) so that roller (4) is dimension b at the
notch at both ends of cam (3).
Dimension b: 0 - 1 mm
TEwOO137
- ‘6 - I/.
TEWW 140 / TEwOOm
4. Bucket lever
Operate the lift lever and adjust the length of
rod (2) so that roller (7) is dimension C at the
notch at both ends of cam (8).
Dimension C: 0 - 1 mm
TBwoo721
20-40
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING WORK EQUIPMENT HYDRAULIC PRESURE
MEASURING WORK
EQUIPMENT HYDRAULIC
PRESSURE
* Measurement conditions
. Engine water temperature: Within green range
on engine water temperature gauge
. Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 - 55%
. Engine speed: High idling
20-41
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING WORK EQUIPMENT HYDRAULIC PRESURE
go-42
iESTlNG AND ADJUSTING MEASURING PPC VALVE PRESSURE
Measuring
1. Raise boom (l), set boom prop (2), set the bucket
to an angle of approximately 45” (not to the
maximum dump position) and remove front
cover (3).
ASet the prop securely.
2. Stop the engine, loosen the oil supply cap, re-
lease the pressure inside the hydraulic oil tank,
then stroke the bucket control lever between the
tilt and neutral positions at least 40 times to
completely release the accumulator pressure.
* Be sure to stop the engine before operating
the lever.
* After the accumulator pressure is completely
released, set the bucket lever to the dump
position and check that the bucket does not
dump.
3. Remove the work equipment dump cylinder cir-
cuit pressure measurement plug (4).
4. Install hydraulic test kit to the measuring port.
l Connect the hose after installing the hydrau-
lic test kit 90° elbow to the measuring port.
l Check that there is no oil leakage from any
joints.
. Use a hose which is long enough to reach
the operator’s seat.
5. Start the engine, raise the boom about 400 mm,
tilt back the bucket. using the control lever, and
measure the pressure when the relief valve is
activated.
. Be careful not to apply any sudden pressure
to the pressure gauge.
A When removing the hydraulic pressure gauge,
release the pressure inside the circuit in the same
way as when it was installed.
20-43
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING PPC VALVE PRESSURE
,
Adjusting
20-44
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING WORK EQUIPMENT
MEASURING WORK
EQUIPMENT
1 A+ Boom RAISE time
* Measurement conditions
. Engine water temperature: Within green range
on engine water temperature gauge
. Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 - 55°C
. Engine speed: High idling
. Steering position: Neutral
. No load
Measurement method
1. Boom RAISE time TDWOO155
I TDWOO156
TDWO0158
TESTING AND ADJUSTING MEASURING HYDRAULIC DRIFT WORK EQUIMENT
* Measurement conditions
. Engine water temperature: Within green range
on engine water temperature gauge
. Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 - 55°C
l
Stop the engine, leave for 5 minutes, then meas-
ure for 15 minutes.
.
Boom: Horizontal
.
Bucket: Horizontal
.
No load
Measurement method
1. Set the boom and bucket in a horizontal posi-
tion, then stop the engine.
TDWOO160
20-46
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING TESTING AND ADJUSTING BUCKET POSITIONER
Testing
1. Stop the engine and check that the clearance
between switch (I) and angle (2) is the standard
value.
Adjusting
1. Lower the bucket to the ground, operate the
bucket to the desired digging angle, then return
the lever to HOLD and stop the engine.
a
2. Adjust nut (4) of switch (I) so that clearance a
from the tip of switch protector (3) to the switch
sensing surface is the standard value, then se-
cure the switch in position.
* Clearance a: 0.5 - 1.0 mm
QEI Switch mounting nut: 17.7 + 2 Nm 4
3*
(1.8 + 0.2 kgm)
1
TBvm478
3. Using shims, adjust the switch protector so that
the clearance b between the switch (1) sensing
surface and angle (2) is the standard value, then
secure the switch in that position.
* Check that the switch sensing surface and
the angle are not in contact.
* Adjust with shims so that the clearance be-
tween the switch sensing surface and the
angle is the standard value at the full stroke
of the angle, then lock in position.
* After adjusting, operate the bucket lever and
check that the bucket positioner is actuated
at the desired position.
* Check that the switch sensing surface and
angle do not slip from the center, then lock
them in position.
* Clearance b: 3 - 7 mm
20-47
TESTING AND ADJUSTING TESTING AND ADJUSTING BOOM KICK-OUT
Testing
1. Stop the engine, and check that the clearance
2.
between switch (1) and plate (2) is the standard
value.
--;1
2
Adjusting
1. Raise the boom to the desired position and mark
it at the position where the center of the switch
is at the lower end of the plate.
20-48
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING TESTING AND ADJUSTING BOOM KICK-OUT
I TEWO0166
%oximity switch
actuation Lights up Goes out
pilot lamp
When detector is positioned at detection When detector has moved away from
Ietector position
surface of proximity switch detection surface of proximity switch
3ucket
aositioner
Proximity switch
Proximity switch
/
3oom kick-out
TEW00170
Boom
Proximitv
Boom kick-out
(machines
equipped with
MDC monitor)
I \ TEW00172
TEWO0171
TESTING AND ADJUSTING ADJUSTING MAIN MONITOR
Adjustment procedure
l Turn off the power, then remove the main moni-
tor and adjust the switches at the back of the
speedometer.
1. Setting machine model
1) Remove the rubber caps from dipswitches
(l), (2), (3), and (4) at the back of the speed-
ometer.
2) When the rubber cap is removed, a rotary
switch can be seen inside. Using a flat-
headed screwdriver, turn this switch to ad-
just it to the settings in the table below.
TDWO0174
Switch 1 Switch 2 Switch 3
(speedom- (tachom-
Tire size (model
eter cor- eter input
selection) rection) selection)
20.5x25-12PR DIP SW 1,2,3
(L-3) 1 7 0
17.5x25-1 2PR
(L-3) 1 c 0 DIP SW 4
Switch
1 Without
Switch 4
With
Reference
Amount of correction for switch (2)
No. E.C.S.S. E.C.S.S. (
1 ON ON correction (%) +I4 +I2 +lO +8 +6 +4 +2 +0
2 ON ON
3 ON OFF
4 ON ON
20-50
0
TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (Chassis related) (T mode) .............. 20-401
20-I 01
0
TROUBLESHOOTING POINTS TO REMEMBER WHEN TROUBLESHOOTING
A Stop the machine in a level place, and check that the safety pin, blocks, and parking brake are securely fitted.
A When carrying out the operation with two or more workers, keep strictly to the agreed signals, and do not
allow any unauthorized person to come near.
A If the radiator cap is removed when the engine is hot, hot water may spurt out and cause burns, so wait for
the engine to cool down before starting troubleshooting.
A Be extremely careful not to touch any hot parts or to get caught in any rotating parts.
A When disconnecting wiring, always disconnect the negative (-1 terminal of the battery first.
A When removing the plug or cap from a location which is under pressure from oil, water, or air, always release
the internal pressure first. When installing measuring equipment, be sure to connect it properly.
The aim of troubleshooting is to pinpoint the basic cause of the failure, to carry out repairs swiftly, and to
prevent reoccurrence of the failure.
When carrying out troubleshooting, and important point is of course to understand the structure and function.
However, a short cut to effective troubleshooting is to ask the operator various questions to form some idea
of possible causes of the failure that would produce the reported symptoms.
1. When carrying out troubleshooting, do not hurry 4) Check the stroke of the control’valve spool.
to disassemble the components. 5) Other maintenance items can be checked ex-
If components are disassembled immediately any ternally, so check any item that is considered
failure occurs: to be necessary.
. Parts that have no connection with the fail- 4. Confirming failure 8
ure or other unnecessary parts will be disas- . Confirm the extent of the failure yourself, z
sembled. and judge whether to handle it as a real fail- 3
. It will become impossible to find the cause ure or as a problem with the method of op-
of the failure. eration, etc.
It will also cause a waste of manhours, parts, or t When operating the machine to reenact
oil or grease, and at the same time, will also lose the troubleshooting symptoms, do not
the confidence of the user or operator. carry out any investigation or measure-
For this reason, when carrying out troubleshoot- ment that may make the problem worse.
ing, it is necessary to carry out thorough prior 5. Troubleshooting
investigation and to carry out troubleshooting in . Use the results of the investigation and in-
accordance with the fixed procedure. spection in Items 2 - 4 to narrow down the
2. Points to ask user or operator causes of failure, then use the troubleshoot-
1) Have any other problems occurred apart from ing flowchart to locate the position of the
the problem that has been reported? failure exactly.
2) Was there anything strange about the ma- t The basic procedure for troubleshooting
chine before the failure occurred? is as follows.
3) Did the failure occur suddenly, or were there I) Start from the simple points.
problems with the machine condition before 2) Start from the most likely points.
this? 3) Investigate other related parts or in-
4) Under what conditions did the failure occur? formation.
5) Had any repairs been carried out before the 6. Measures to remove root cause of failure
failure? . Even if the failure is repaired, if the root cause
When were these repairs carried out? of the failure is not repaired, the same failure
6) Has the same kind of failure occurred be- will occur again.
fore? To prevent this, always investigate why the
3. Check before troubleshooting problem occurred. Then, remove the root
1) Check the oil level cause.
2) Check for any external leakage of oil from
the piping or hydraulic equipment.
3) Check the travel of the control levers.
20-102
0
TROUBLESHOOTING SEQUENCE OF EVENTS IN TROUBLESHOOTING
er of machine
ils of jobsite, etc.
2) Ask questions to gain an outline of the prob
lem.
* Condition of failure TEW00182
- Work being carried out at the time of the
failure
- Operating environment
* Past history, details of maintenance, etc.
J
\
step 2 TEW00183
/Determlnlng probable location of cause
’ m,
TEW00184
Step 3
Preparatton of troubleshooting tools
oa
11 Look at the table of troubleshootlng tools in
the shop manual and prepare the necessary
tools. * Pinpoint locations of failure (carry out
* T-adapter troubleshooting)
. Hydraulic pressure gauge kit, etc. * Decide action to take
21 Look an the parts book and prepare the nec-
essary replacement parts. 1) Before starting troubleshooting, locate and
repair simple failures.
- Check before starting items
- Other check items
21 See the Tr%ubleshooting Section of the shop
f
manual. select a troubleshooting flowchart
that matches the symptoms, and carry out
TEW00188
20- 103
TROUBLESHOOTING PRECAUTIONS WHEN CARRYING OUT MAINTENANCE
20- 104
0
TROUBLESHOOTING PRECAUTIONS WHEN CARRYING OUT MAINTENANCE
Disconnecting connectors
(1) Hold the connectors when disconnect-
ing. when removing
When disconnecting the connectors, hold
the connectors and not the wires.
For connectors held by a screw, loosen
the screw fully, then hold the male and
female connectors in each hand and pull
apart. For connectors which have a lock TEW00197
Connecting connectors
(I) Check the connector visually.
a. Check that there is no oil, dirt, or TEWOOlSS
20-106
0
TROUBLESHOOTING PRECAUTIONS WHEN CARRYING OUT MAINTENANCE
1 q ' TEW00202
TROUBLESHOOTING PRECAUTIONS WHEN CARRYING OUT MAINTENANCE
I/ TEWOO206
20-108
0
TROUBLESHOOTING PRECAUTIONS WHEN CARRYING OUT MAINTENANCE
3) Sealing openings
After any piping or equipment is removed,
the openings should be sealed with caps,
tapes, or vinyl bags to prevent any dirt or
dust from entering. If the opening is left open
or is blocked with a rag, there is danger of -
dirt entering or of the surrounding area be-
ing made dirty by leaking oil so never do
this.
Do not simply drain oil out on to the ground,
collect it and ask the customer to dispose of
it, or take it back with you for disposal. TEW00208
TEW00209
20-l 09
0
TROUBLESHOOTING PRECAUTIONS WHEN CARRYING OUT MAINTENANCE
61 Flushing operations
After disassembling and assembling the
oil
equipment, or changing the oil, use flushing
oil to remove the contaminants, sludge, and
old oil from the hydraulic circuit.
Normally, flushing is carried out twice: pri-
mary flushing is carried out with flushing
oil, and secondary flushing is carried out
with the specified hydraulic oil. 8
m
TEW00210 q
3
7) Cleaning operations
After repairing the hydraulic equipment
(pump, control valve, etc.) or when running
the machine, carry out oil cleaning to re-
move the sludge or contaminants in the hy-
draulic oil circuit.
The oil cleaning equipment is used to re-
move the ultrafine (about 31.1)particles that
the filter built into the hydraulic equipment
cannot remove, so it is an extremely effec-
tive device.
TEWOOZll
20-110
0
TROUBLESHOOTING HANDLING CONNECTORS
HANDLING CONNECTORS
1. When removing the connectors from the clips,
pull the connector in a parallel direction to the
clip.
Sr If the connector is twisted to the left and *
right or up and down, the housing may
break.
I TBW00485
TEWOX86
TBWWb87
20-m
1
._
TROUBLESHOOTING CHECKS BEFORE TROUBLESHOOTING
20412
0
TROUBLESHOOTING METHOD OF USING TROUBLESHOOTING CHARTS
20-114
0
TROUBLESHOOTING METHOD OF USING TROUBLESHOOTING CHARTS
I Cause I Remedy
Defective contact, or
(3) disconnection in wiring After inspectior
YES
harness between CNLOG repair or replac
1 I (female) (8) and CNL43
(male)
Does buzzer
sound? 2 YES
Defective buzzer Replace
_ Is voltage between
1) Turn starting CNL42 (female)
switch ON. NO and chassis Defective contact, or
2) Contact CNL43 ground normal? disconnection in wiring After inspectiol
(female) to NO harness between CNL42 repair or replac
1)20-30V
chassis ground. (female) and CNFSZ (9)
2) Turn starting
switch ON.
x
TAW00722
(4)
+ Before carrying out troubleshooting, check that all the related connectors are properly inserted.
* Always connect any disconnected connectors before going on the next step.
20-l 15
i_,
TROUBLESHOOTING METHOD OF USING TROUBLESHOOTING CHARTS
[Questions]
Sections @ + @ in the chart on the right corre-
sponds to the items where answers can be ob-
tained from the user. The items in @ are items
that can be obtained from the user, depending
on the user’s level.
[Check items]
The serviceman carries out simple inspection to
narrow down the causes. The items under @ in
the chart on the right correspond to this.
The serviceman narrows down the causes from
information eg that he has obtained from the
user and the results of 0 that he has obtained
from his own inspection.
[Troubleshooting]
Troubleshooting is carried out in the order of
probability, starting with the causes that have
been marked as having the highest probability
from information gained from [Questions] and
[Check items].
20-l 16
3
TROUBLESHOOTING METHOD OF USING TROUBLESHOOTING CHARTS
20-l 17
0
TROUBLESHOOTING METHOD OF USING TROUBLESHOOTING CHARTS
20-118
3,
TROUBLESHOOTING METHOD OF USING TROUBLESHOOTING CHARTS
Step 1
w
Three
I
symptoms
I Step 2
Step 1. Questioning the operator 1. Steering does not work t Symptom [Exam-
The questions to ask the operator are given plel
below the failure symptom. If the answers
to the questions match the information given, Ask the operator about the following points.
follow the arrow to reach the probable cause . Did the steering suddenly stop work-
of the failure. ing? + Breakage in steering equipment
Consider the contents of the questions and . Had the steering gradually been becom-
consult the table while proceeding to Steps ing heavy? + Internal wear of steering
2 and 3 to grasp the true cause. equipment, defective seal
NO.
Step 3. Using cross-reference table
1) Operate the machine to carry out the
checks in the troubleshooting item col-
umn.
Mark the items where the results match
the symptom.
+ It is not necessary to follow the trou-
bleshooting checks in order; follow
an order which is easiest to carry
out troubleshooting.
2) Find the appropriate cause from the [Example 21
cause column. If the symptom appears,
the o marks on that line indicate the pos-
sible causes. (For item No. 2 in the table
on the right, the possible causes are c or
e.)
If there is only one 0: \ Remedy/. , /_
Carry out the other troubleshooting items
(where the same cause is marked with
o), check if the symptom appears, then
repair.
If there are two 0s:
Go on to Step 3) to narrow down the
possible causes.
20- 120
a
TROUBLESHOOTING METHOD OF USING TROUBLESHOOTING CHARTS
7) Remedy
If the causes are narrowed down to one com-
mon cause, take the aciton given in the rem-
edy column.
The symbols given in the remedy column
indicate the following:
X: Replace, n: Repair, A; Adjust, C: Clean
20-121
0
TROUBLESHOOTING OF ENGINE SYSTEM
(S MODE)
20-201
0
TROUBLESHOOTING S-l
. The specific gravity should exceed the value for the chargin
rate of 70% in the above table.
. In cold weather the specific gravity must exceed the value f
the charging rate of 75% in the above table.
Legend
0 : Possible causes (judging from Questions and check items)
0 : Most probable causes (judging from Questions and Check items)
A : Possible causes due to length of use (used for a long period)
l : Items to confirm the cause
I’i I I
not return (when blind plug at rear of pump is removed, it
can be seen that plunger control sleeve does not move) I I I I I I I I I I I
1 When fuel cap is inspected directly, it is found to be clogged
Remedy
TROUBLESHOOTING s-2
Legend
0: Possible causes (judging from Questions and check items)
0 : Most probable causes (judging from Questions and Check items)
A: Possible causes due to length of use (used for a long period)
l : Items to confirm the cause.
20-203
i,’
TROUBLESHOOTING s-2
General causes why engine turns but no exhaust gas comes out
. Supply of fuel impossible
l Supply of fuel is extremely small Causes
. improper selection of fuel (particularly in winter)
Standards for use of fuel
Ambient temprature
Legend
0: Possible causes (judging from Questions and check items)
0 : Most probable causes (judging from Questions and Check items)
n : Possible causes due to length of use (used for a long period)
l : Items to confirm the cause.
Confirm recent repair history
Exhaust gas suddenly stops coming out (when starting again) 000
20-204
0
TROUBLESHOOTING s-2
Legend
0 : Possible causes (judging from Questions and check items)
8 : Most probable causes (judging from Questions and Chedc items)
A : Possible causes due to length of use fused for a long period)
0 : Items to confirm the cause.
Confirm recent repair history
Degree of use 1Operated for long period AAA A
Suddenly failed to start 00
When engine is cranked, abnormal noise is heard from
around head loi I I I I I I I I I I
2) Little fuel comes out even when fuel filter air bleed plug
is loosened 00 C
There is leakage from fuel piping 0
When exhaust manifold is touched immediately after
starting engine, temperature of some cylinder is low
Legend
0 : Possible causes (judging from Questions and check items1
Q : Most probable causes (judging from Questions and Check items)
A : Possible causes due to length of use (used for a long period)
0 : Items to confirm the cause.
I I I I I I I I I / I
20-206
0
TROUBLESHOOTING S-4
Legend
0 : Possible causes (judging from Questions and check items1
0 : Most probable causes (judging from Questions and Check items)
n : Possible causes due to length of use (used for a long period)
0 : Items to confirm the cause.
Rust and water are found when fuel is drained I I I I I I I IQIQI I I I . .ID
Metal particles are found when oil is drained lola I I I I lolol I I I z
20-207
T
TROUBLESHOOTING s-5
Legend
0: Possible causes (judging from Questions and check items)
0 : Most probable causes (judging from Questions and Check items)
n : Possible causes due to length of use (used for a long period)
l : Items to confirm the cause.
I I I I I I I I I I
When fuel filter, strainer are inspected directly. they are
found to be clogged I I I I I I
20-208
0
TROUBLESHOOTING S-6
Remedy
20-209
0
TROUBLESHOOTING s-7
Legend
0 : Possible causes (judging from Questions and check items)
Q : Most probable causes (judging from Questions and Check items)
not return
20-210
0
TROUBLESHOOTING S-8
Legend
0 : Possible causes (judging from Questions and check items)
Q : Most probable causes (judging from Questions and Check items)
: Possible causes due to length of use (used for a long period)
Legend
0 : Possible causes (judging from Questions and check items)
0 : MOS probable causes (judging from Questions and Check iTems)
: Possible
,f~ causes due to length of use (used for a long period)
l : Items to confirm the cause.
~&;rmally excessive
Amount of blow-by gas
Oil filter caution lamp stavs on even when oil pressure rises
Legend
0: Possible causes (judging from Questions and check items)
0: Most probable causes (judging from Questions and Check items)
n : Possible causes due to length of use (used for a long period)
l : Items to confirm the cause
20-2 13
0
TROUBLESHOOTING S-l 1
S-11 Oil is in cooling water, or water spurts back, or water level goes
down
General causes why oil is in cooling water
. internal leakage in lubrication system
. Internal leakage in cooling system
I Causes I
Legend
0: Possible causes (judging from Questions and check items)
0 : Most probable causes (judging from Quenions and Check items)
n : Possible causes due to length of use (used for a long period)
l : items to confirm the cause.
F
8
.=
Y
8
When hydraulic oil, torque converter, transmission oil is drained, water is
6 found
I I I I I
20-214
0
TROUBLESHOOTING s-12
Type of oil
Engine oil
Legend
C : Possible causes (judging from Questions and check items)
: Most probable causes (judging from Questions and Check items)
Legend
0: Possible causes (judging from Questions and check items)
0 : Most probable causes (judging from Questions and Check items)
/J: Possible causes due to length of use fused for a long period)
l : Items fo confirm the cause.
i
abnormal numbe
E
.%
::
2
damper chamber
20-216
0
TROUBLESHOOTING s-14
Condition of overheating
g
.o
Water temperature gauge
s
a
I
Radiator water level sensor lights up 0
8
k
f
I When light bulb is held behind radiator, no light passes through 1 101 I I I I I I I I I I
I Water is leaking because of cracks in hose or loose clamps I I I I I IQI I I I I I I
I Belt tension is found to be slack I I %I I I I 101 I I I I I
Power train oil temperature enters red range before engine
water temperature
I I I I I I I I I I I loI
2
pressure is found to be low
20-2 17
(i7
TROUBLESHOOTING s-15
Legend
0: Possible causes (judging from Questions and check items)
0 : Most probable causes (judging from Questions and Check items)
n : Possible causes due to length of use (used for a long period)
l : Items to confirm the cause.
20-2 18
0
TROUBLESHOOTING S-16
Causes
Legend
0: Possible causes (judging from Duestions and check items)
0 : Most probable causes (judging from Duestions and Check items)
n : Possible causes due to length of use (used for a long period)
l : Items to confirm the cause.
TROUBLE DATA DISPLAY . .. ....... .. .......... .... ........... .. .. ...... ... ......... ............ ... ...... ... .. .......... .. ...... .... .......... . 20-253
20-251
0
M-14 When parking brake dragging warning is given, buzzer and caution lamp
are actuated continuously, or they are not actuated ............................................................ 20-274
(a) Actuated continuously ........................................................................................................ 20-274
(b) Not actuated ........................................................................................................................ .20-274
M-15 Abnormality in buzzer.. ............................................................................................................. 20-275
(a) Buzzer does not sound when starting switch is turned ON (during self-check)..........20-27 5
(b) Buzzer always sounds ........................................................................................................ 20-275
M-16 Condition of monitor switches is not stored in memory ..................................................... 20-276
M-17 Abnormality in failure display mode ...................................................................................... 20-277
(a) Does not enter failure display mode ................................................................................ 20-277
(b) Time for time elapsed since failure on failure display mode does not advance ...... ..20-27 7
M-18 Abnormality in emergency steering normal display.. ........................................................... 20-278
(a) Emergency steering normal display does not light up .................................................. 20-278
(b) Emergency steering normal display stays lighted up .................................................... 20-278
M-19 Abnormality in emergency steering actuation display ......................................................... 20-279
(a) Emergency steering actuation display does not light up.. ............................................. 20-279
(b) Emergency steering actuation display stays lighted up.. ............................................... 20-279
M-20 Abnormality in auto-greasing system.. ................................................................................... 20-280
(a) Forced greasing cannot be carried out ............................................................................. 20-280
(b) Monitor display flashes rapidly (2 times/set). .................................................................. 20-280
(c) When no more grease remains, monitor display flashes rapidly (2 times/set) ......... ..20-28 0 8
Z
(d) Monitor display flashes slowly (1 time/set). .................................................................... 20-281
(e) Monitor display goes out.. ................................................................................................. 20-281 5
M-21 Abnormality in ECSS system ................................................................................................... 20-282
(a) Display does not change when switch is pressed .......................................................... 20-282
(b) Monitor display lights up but ECSS function does not work ........................................ 20-282
M-22 Buzzer does not sound when auto-leveling switch is actuated ........................................... 20-282
M-23 Failure code is not sent to main monitor (abnormality in network) ................................... 20-283
20-252
0
TROUBLESHOOTING TROUBLE DATA DISPLAY
20-253
0
TROUBLESHOOTING TROUBLE DATA DISPLAY
Action code: “EOCl+CALL” means that EOD and CALL are displayed alternately
(1
48 Bucket kickout relay system
54 Abnormality in model
selection I
20-254
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-l
Cause Remedy
Power source
TDW00285
20-255
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-2
F
Cause Remedy
1 YES
Defective main monitor Replace
Is voltage
between CNL05
(4) and chassis Defective contact, or
ground normal?
I disconnection in wiring After inspection
1)20-30V NO harness between CNL05 repair or replace
2) Turn starting (female) (4) and CNL57 (3)
switch START.
Neutral relay
r
Start signal,
neutral signal
CNL57
Starting motor w
CNL04
CNLR5
J-Starting switch
TDW00266
20-256
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-3
2 YES
Defective main monitor Replace
is resistance
YES between CNL07
(female) (1) and Defective contact, or
1 disconnection in wiring
- (2) normal? After inspection
Is resistance harness between CNL07
1)50OR-1 kQ NO repair or replace
between CNTOG (female) (l), (2) - CNTLZ
- 2) Turn starting (1). (2) - CNTOG (l), (2)
(male) (11 and (2)
switch OFF.
normal?
3) Disconnect
1)500R-1 kf2 CNL07.
2) Turn starting Defective speed sensor Replace
switch OFF. NO
3) Disconnect
CNTOG.
Speedometer
/y/j/Q
3
.a
TOW00287
20-257
0
TROUBLESHOOTlNG M-4
Cause Remedy
1 YES
>efective main monitor leplace
Is voltage
between CNLOB
(7) and chassis Iefective contact, or
ground normal? jisconnection in wiring &her inspection
NO iarness between CNLOB epair or replace
1)20-30V
female) (7) and CNLO4 (2)
2) Turn starting
switch ON.
3) Directional
lever: F
1 YES
H
3efective main monitor Ieplace
Is voltage
between CNL08
(8) and chassis lefective contact, or
around normal? disconnection in wiring After inspection
NO iarness between CNLOB epair or replacs
1)20-30V
‘female) (8) and CNL04 (4)
2) Turn starting
switch ON.
3) Directional
lever: R
20-258
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-4
1 YES
lefective main monitor leplace
Is voltage
between CNLOB
(7) and chassis Zontact of power source
ground normal? vith wiring harness
rfter inspection
>etween CNL08 (female)
l)O-5v NO epair or replace
7) and CNL04 (2). or
2) Turn starting fefective control lever
switch ON.
3) Directional
lever: N
1 YES
15
Iefective main monitor leplace
Is voltage
between CNLOB
(12) and chassis Iefective contact, or
ground normal?
fisconnection in wiring dter inspection
1)20-30V NO larness between CNLOB epair or replact
2) Turn starting female) (12) and CNL04 (5)
switch ON.
z 31 Speed lever: 1
5
(f) Does not display 3rd, 4th
1 YES
Iefective main monitor leplace
Is voltage
between CNLOS
113) and chassis cIefectivecontact, or
I
ground normal? ‘5 rher inspection
Clisconnection in wiring
apair or replact
NO trarness between CNLOS
1)20-30V
2) Turn starting (female) (13) and CNLO4 (7)
switch ON.
3) Speed lever: 3
I H I L I 1 I
I L I L I 2 I
I L I H I 3 I
H H 4
20-259
fi7
TROUBLESHOOTING M-4
Cause Remedy
1 YES
Iefective main monitor qeplace
Is voltage
between CNL05
(12) and chassis Zontact of power source
ground normal? vith wiring harness
4fter inspectior
)etween CNL05 (female)
l)O-5v NO ‘epair or replac
12) and CNL04 (5). or
2) Turn starting fefective control lever
switch ON.
3) Speed lever: 2
Transmission range
TDW00288
20-260
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-5
Remedy
, ;;r Xeplace
Is there continuity
YES between CNLOG
(female) (13) and Defective contact, or
1 chassis ground? disconnection in wiring 4her inspectior
Is voltage harness between CNLOG ,epair or replac
1) Turn starting NO
(female) (13) and CNLOZ (3)
between CNLOG _ switch OFF.
(12) and chassis 2) Disconnect
ground normal? CNLOG.
1120-30V 3) Dimmer switch: Defective contact, or
2) Turn starting Hi beam disconnection in wiring 4her inspectior
switch ON. NO harness between CNLOG ,epair or replac
(female) (12) and CNFSP (21
Hi beam
CNLOG CNFS2
CNL02
Lamp switch
a
(-t 3
Dimmer switch
@ a
TDW00290
20-26 1
iT?
TROUBLESHOOTING M-6
Cause Remedy
1 YES
Defective main monitor Replace
Is voltage
between CNLOG
(14) and chassis 3 Defective contact, or
ground normal? disconnection in wiring After inspection
harness between CNLOG repair or replace
1) Repeat OV and NO
(female) (14) and CNL03 (4)
20-30V.
2) Turn starting
switch ON.
1 YES
Defective main monitor Replace
Is voltage
between CNLOG
(15) and chassis Defective contact, or
ground normal? disconnection in wiring After inspection
harness between CNLOG repair or replact
1) Repeat 0 V and NO
(female) (15) and CNLOB (3)
zo-3ov.
2) Turn starting
switch ON.
_Lfi
I CNL12
I I I
Hazard switch
TOW00291
20-262
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-7
3 YES
1 Ir -t >efective main monitor qeplace
[ >efectivecontact, or
jisconnection in wiring
4fter inspectior
larness between CNLOG repair or replac
Is there continuity female) (11) - CNTLZ (3) -
YES between CNT08 2j Turn starting
I
:NT08 (female) (1)
- (female) (21 and switch ON.
1 chassis ground? 3) Turn parking
switch OFF. Iefective contact, or
Is there continuity 1) Disconnect disconnection in wiring
between CNT08 CNT08. 4fter inspectior
larness between CNT08
(male) (1) and repair or replac
NO ,female) (2) - CNTLl (8) -
(2)? :hassis ground
1) Disconnect
defective parking brake
CNTOB. Replace
ndicator switch
2) Turn starting NO
switch ON.
3) Turn parking
switch OFF.
Parking signal
Parking brake
CNTL2 CNT08 indicator switch
CNTLI
I
?77 TDWOOZSZ
20-263
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-9
Cause Remedy
TDW00295
20-267
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-10
Cause Remedy
(a1 Neither monitor display nor front working lamp light up
Defective contact, or
YES disconnection in wiring 4fter inspection
harness between CNLGO (1) .epair or replact
- CNLOB (171, CNCLl (7)
1
Defective front working
) qeplace
lamp relay
between CNLGO
Is voltage
(1) and chassis
YES between CNLGO Defective contact, or
ground normal?
(6) and chassis 4 YEE disconnection in wiring 4fter inspection
l)O-3v ground normal? Is voltage harness between CNLOG .epair or replace
2) Turn starting 2p
between CNLOG (1) and CNLGO (6)
- l)O-3v
switch ON. Is voltage between ~,JO (1) and chassis
2) Turn starting
_ CNLGO (2). (5) and ground normal?
- switch ON.
NO chassis ground Defective main monitor qeplace
normal? l)O-3v NO
2) Turn starting
1)20-30V
switch ON. Defective contact, or
2) Turn starting
disconnection in wiring 4fter inspection
switch ON.
NO harness between CNLGO ,epair or replace
(2). (5) - CNFS5 (1)
(b) Working lamp lights up but monitor display does not light up
1 YES
Defective main monitor qeplace
between CNL05
(17) and chassis
Defective contact, or
ground normal? lfter inspection
disconnection in wiring
1)20-30V harness between CNLOB ,epair or replacf
2) Turn starting [female) (17) and CNLGO (1)
switch ON.
20-268
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-11
Cause Remedy
(a) Neither monitor display nor rear working lamp light up
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
YES After inspection,
larness between CNL61
repair or replace
1) - CNL05 (181, CNLRl
12)
(b) Working lamp lights up but monitor display does not light up
1 YES
Defective main monitor
Is voltage
between CNLOS
(18) and chassis Defective contact, or
ground normal? disconnection in wiring
After inspection
harness between CNL05
1)20-30V NO repair or replace
[female) (18) and CNL61
2) Turn starting 11)
switch ON.
20-269
iT)
TROUBLESHOOTING M-II
Working lamp F
N
CNL05 IO@O@(?)~ I CNCLl
1 To front working lamp
CNLOG 0 CNFS5
+24v
m
R Working lamp relay CNL61
Working lamp R
CNLOS CNLRI
c To rear working lamp
I
CNLOG CNFS5
+24V
TDW00296
20-270
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-12
* Before carrying out troubleshooting, check that all the related connectors are properly inserted.
* Always connect any disconnected connectors before going on the next step.
l)O-3v
2) Turn starting NO Defective main monitor leplace
switch ON.
20-271
CJ
TROUBLESHOOTING M-12
Cause Remedy
(c) Monitor display lights up but cut-off function is not actuated
\ ‘ES
3efective cut-off relay Replace
YE between CNL65
(2) and chassis 3 YES
Iefective main monitor Replace
III
Transmission cut-off
+24V
Transmission lever
CNL08
m
n cut-off switch
d7
”
CNTLI
f
3 --t
3 -
F solenoid
6 5(
I
5
1 r
R solenoid
T
Neutralizer relay FORWARD relay REVERSE relay
CNL58 CNL66 CNL67
TDW00297
20-272
G?
TROUBLESHOOTING M-13
1 YES
Defective main monitor F7eplace
Is voltage II
between CNL05
(8) and chassis Defective contact, or
ground normal? disconnection in wiring I Afterinspection
NO harness between CNLOB r,epair or replacf
1)20-30V
(female) (8) and CNL04 (3)
2) Turn starting
switch ON.
w
I 1
Start signal,
neutral signal
CNL57
Starting motor
TDW00286
20-273
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-14
Cause Remedy
1) Turn staning
Defective main monitor Replace
switch ON. NO
2) Disconnect
CNL07.
CNL07 CNLIS
TOW00300
20-274
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-15
Cause Remedy
(a1 Buzzer does not sound when starting switch is
turned ON (during self-check)
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring After inspectior
YES harness between CNLOG .epair or replac
1 (female) (8) and CNL43
(male)
Does buzzer
sound? 2 YES qeplace
Defective buzzer
d Is voltage between
1) Turn starting _ CNL42 (female)
switch ON. NO and chassis Defective contact, or
ground normal? disconnection in wiring After inspectior
2) Contact CNL43
harness between CNL42 ,epair or replac
(female) to 1)20-30V NO
chassis ground. (female) and CNFS2 (9)
2) Turn starting
switch ON.
CNLOG CNL43
Maintenance monitor
> 1
TOW00301
20-275
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-16
Remedy
1 YES
Defective main monitor Replace
Is voltage
between CNL07
(10) and chassis Defective contact, or
ground normal? disconnection in wiring After inspection
1)20-30V NO harness between CNL07 repair or replace
2) Turn starting (female) (101 and CNLOS (2)
switch ON.
CNL07 CNLOS
Starting switch
CNLR4
- To battery relay
TOW00302
20-276
a
TROUBLESHOOTING M-17
Cause Remedy
1 YES
Iefective main monitor ieplace
Is voltage
between CNLOS Iefective contact, or
(5) and chassis jisconnection in wiring
ground normal? larness between CNL05
Uter inspection
female) (5) - CNLRI (6) -
1)20-30V NO epair or replace
3NERl (9) -alternator
2) Start engine. :erminal R, or defective
alternator
Charge
r. Alternator
CNL05 CNLR4 CNERI
CNEIG
20-277
l?
TROUBLESHOOTING M-18
1 Cause Remedy
Emergency steering
CNL05 CNTLl
20-278
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-19
Cause IRemedy
-
(a1 Emergency steering actuation display does not light up
Iefective emergency
Ilace
steering function sensor
3 YES
Iefective main monitor Ret >lace
Yl
Wring harness between
.L jZ%GJHP INLO (female) (11) -
Aftt ?r inspection
ZNTLl (1) - CNTll (female1
l)O-2v NO rep,air or replacf
between CNTll 1) short circuiting with
2) Turn starting :hassis ground
(female) (2) and
switch ON.
)efective contact, or
Is there continuity 1) Disconnect lisconnection in wiring
between CNTll Aftt ?r inspection
CNTll. rarness between CNTll
rep,air or replacf
Female) (2) - CNTLl (8) -
hassis ground
1) Disconnect
CNTll. jefective emergency
teering actuation sensor Ret rlace
2) Turn starting JO
switch ON.
Emergency steering
CNL05 CNTLl CNTll actuation sensor
@ 3
@ 3
I
20-279
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-20
Cause Remedy
YES
Defective main monitor Ieplace
1 t
Defective contact, or
I
(5) and chassis
around norm
“” n-1 Is voltage
2 YES
I I
disconnection in wiring
harness between CNL08
(female) (5) and CNGRE (3)
4fter inspectior
epair or replac
YES
Defective main monitor ieplace
14
2) Turn starting Go to
switch ON. operation maintenance -
1)20-30V NO manual for handling
2) Turn starting auto-greasing system
switch ON.
20-280
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-20
Cause Remedy
Go to
operation maintenance
-
manual for handling
auto-greasing system
YES
Defective main monitor Replace
1
Is voltage
between CNL07 Contact of power source
(11) and chassis 2 YES with wiring harness After inspection
ground normal? Is voltage between between CNL07 (female1 repair or replace
CNGRE (female) (11) and CNGRE (female) (2)
l)O-3v
2) Turn starting NO (2) and chassis Go to
switch ON. ground normal? operation maintenance
-
NO manual for handling
l)O-3v
auto-greasing system
2) Turn starting
switch ON.
3) Disconnect
CNGRE.
I L
I
H
I
ON
I
Auto-greasing
CNLOG CNGRE
3
CNL07
A -3
CNL08
TDW00309
TROUBLESHOOTING M-21, M-22
Cause Remedy
CNLOG CNDP2
TDW00310
I
auto-leveling switch is actuated
Go to
2 YES Defective auto-leveling Troubleshootin!
controller for auto-levelin!
Is resistance between
controller
YES_ CNL34 tmak) (7) and _
Defective contact, or
chassis ground
1 disconnection in wiring
-, normal? After inspection
harness between CNL08
NO repair or replacl
Does buzzer 1)2kQ-4k.Q (female) (6) and CNL34
sound? - 2) Turn starting (male) (7)
switch OFF.
3) Disconnect
1) Turn starting CNL34.
switch ON. Defective main monitor Replace
NO
2) Disconnect
CNL34.
3) Connect CNL08
(6) to power
source.
ECSS
CNLOS CNL34
TAWO0493
20-282
0
TROUBLESHOOTING M-23
Cause Remedy
Table
CNDP2
ECSS
Network (If equipped)
CNL08 CNL34
Auto leveling
20-283
(is
TROUBLESHOOTING OF MAINTENANCE
MONITOR SYSTEM
(K MODE)
K- 1 When starting switch is turned ON, all lamps on maintenance monitor do not
light up for 3 seconds, maintenance monitor does not work.. ........................................... .20-302
(a) All lamps on maintenance monitor do not light up for 3 seconds.. ............................ 20-302
(b) Some lamps do not light up ............................................................................................. 20-303
K- 2 When starting switch is turned ON, all lamps on maintenance monitor light up
but do not go out.. .................................................................................................................... 20-303
K- 3 When engine is started immediately after starting switch is turned ON
(within 3 seconds), all lamps on maintenance monitor do not go out.. ............................ 20-304
K- 4 When starting switch is turned ON (engine stopped), CHECK items flash ....................... 20-305
(a) Engine oil level display flashes.. ....................................................................................... 20-305
(b) Engine water level display flashes.. ................................................................................. .20-306
K- 5 When starting switch is turned ON (engine started), CAUTION items flash.. ................... 20-307
(a) Engine oil pressure display flashes .................................................................................. 20-307
(b) Battery charge level display flashes ................................................................................. 20-308
(c) Brake oil pressure display flashes .................................................................................... 20-309
8
(d) Air cleaner display flashes.. ............................................................................................... 20-310
2
5 K- 6 CAUTION items are flashing but alarm buzzer does not sound.. ....................................... .20-311
K- 7 There is no abnormality in monitor display but alarm buzzer sounds.. ............................ 20-312
K- 8 CAUTION items are flashing but warning lamp (CHECK lamp, CAUTION lamp)
does not light up.. ..................................................................................................................... 20-313
(a) CHECK lamp ........................................................................................................................ 20-313
(b) CAUTION lamp.. .................................................................................................................. 20-313
K- 9 There is no abnormality in maintenance monitor display but
warning lamp (CHECK lamp, CAUTION lamp) lights up ..................................................... .20-314
(a) CHECK lamp ........................................................................................................................ 20-314
(b) CAUTION lamp.. .................................................................................................................. 20-314
K-10 Night lighting does not light up when lamp switch is turned ON
(only lighting of maintenance monitor does not light up) .................................................. .20-315
K-11 Night lighting lights up even when lamp switch is OFF, night lighting stays
lighted up ................................................................................................................................... 20-316
K-12 Service meter does not work.. ................................................................................................. 20-317
K-13 Service meter is running even when engine is stopped ..................................................... .20-317
K-14 Abnormality in gauge items .................................................................................................... 20-318
(a) Abnormality in fuel gauge ................................................................................................. 20-318
(b) Abnormality in engine water temperature gauge.. ........................................................ .20-319
(c) Abnormality in torque converter oil temperature gauge .............................................. .20-320
20-301
@
TROUBLESHOOTING K-l
Sr Before carrying out troubleshooting, check that all the related connectors are properly inserted.
* Always connect any disconnected connectors before going on the next step.
Remedy
(a) All lamps on maintenance monitor do not light up
for 3 seconds
Y
:. Replace
Repair wiring
YES harness between CNLl8 harness,
I
Is voltage (female) (1). (2) - CNFS2 replace, or
3
between CNL18 (9) -fuse box - CNFSl replace fuse
(11. (2) - (3) Is voltage between (male) (2), or blown fuse
normal? YES CNFSI (female) (21
and chassis
1)20-30V Defective contact, or
ground normal?
2) Turn starting disconnection in wiring Repair wiring
switch ON. 1)20-30V harness between CNFSl harness,
Is there continuity 1
between CNL18
2) Disconnect Nil
.._ (female) (2) - CNLRG (1) - replace, or
CNFSl. slow blow fuse - battery replace fuse
3) Turn startino I relay, or blown fuse
switch ON. -
1) Turn starting I Defective contact, or
switch OFF. Repair wiring
2) Disconnect harness or
CNL18. replace
20-302
0
TROUBLESHOOTING K-l. K-2
Cause Remedy
Defective maintenance
Replace
monitor module
Cause Remedy
Defective maintenance
Replace
monitor module
20-303
Tis
TROUBLESHOOTING K-3
t Before carrying out troubleshooting, check that all the related connectors are properly inserted.
* Always connect any disconnected connectors before going on the next step.
Cause Remedy
1
When starting
YES Defective maintenance
Replace
monitor module
engine,is voltage
between CNL19
(female) (11 and Defective contact, or
chassis ground disconnection in wiring Repair wiring
normal? harness between CNL19 harness or
- NO (female) (1) and neutral replace
1)20-3ov
relay
2) Disconnect
CNL19.
3) Start engine.
4) Measure when
starting motor is
turning.
CNLOS
Starting switch
Speed lever
I Neutral relay
TDWO0315
20-304
0
TROUBLESHOOTING K-4
Defective maintenance
Replace
monitor module
IIs there continuity1 1 I
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
Repair wiring
harness between CNL18
(female) (13) -CNLRI (4) - ~~~~es Or
CNERl (3) - CNEIO
(female) (1)
Defective engine oil level
Replace
sensor
2) Disconnect
CNElO.
TDW00316
20-305
m
TROUBLESHOOTING u-4
Cause Remedy
(b) Engine water level display flashes
t Before starting troubleshooting, check the engine
water level again.
3 YES rfective maintenance
Replace
onitor module
rfective contact, or
J/El-
sconnection in wiring Repair wiring
lrness between CNL18 harness or
1) Turn starting NO imale) (8) - CNLR3 (2) - replace
switch OFF. rlR06 (female) (1)
(female) (1) and
2) Disconnect
CNLl8. ?fective contact, or
di:sconnection in wiring Repair wiring
between CNROG
I 1) Turn starting
switch OFF.
I# - halrness between CNROG harness or
NO (ff rmale) (2) and chassis replace
2) Disconnect
J CNROG. 9’ ound
1) Turn starting
Dc?fective radiator water
switch OFF. Reolace
lejdel sensor
2) Disconnect
CNROG.
TDW00317
20-306
0
TROUBLESHOOTING K-5
Cause Remedy
CNLR4 CNERI
Ring terminal
3 Engine oil pressure sensor
+24V I>CI
t.
&I@@~
CNL64
TDWOO318
20-307
f??
TROUBLESHOOTING K-5
Cause Remedy
I
Is voltage between (female) (12) - CNLR4 (6) - larness or
alternator terminal R 1)20-30V NO CNERl (9) -alternator eplace
and chassis ground 2) Start engine. terminal R
normal?
1)20-30V (eplace
Defective alternator
2) Start engine. NO
Starting motor
CNR04 Alternator
Battery relay
TDW00319
20-308
(i;
TROUBLESHOOTING K-5
Cause Remedy
(c) Brake oil pressure display flashes
1
‘ES between CNB13
(female) (2) and (female) (1). or defective
diode
I
Is there continuity 2) Disconnect harness between CNB13 Rlepair wiring
YE between CNBOB CNB13. L (female) (2) and CNB08 h#arness or
(male) (1) and hIO (female) (1). or between rieplace
(2)? CNB08 (female) (2) -
1 CNBRl (4) -chassis grounc I
1) Start engine
Is there continuity 2) Disconnect
Defective brake
CNB08.
accumulator charge oil
ieplace
N pressure switch (CNB08
end)
1) Sdrt engine.
2) Disconnect Defective brake
CNB13. accumulator charge oil
leplace
IO pressure switch (CNB13
end)
CN41
DI
@ 3
@l i-3
TDW00320
20-309
0
TROUBLESHOOTING K-5
Remedy
(d) Air cleaner display flashes
F
,YES 1 r;M;trive dust indicator
Replace
1
Replace
YE Defective contact, or
between CNL18
disconnection in wiring
(female) (15) and
harness between CNL18
(female) (151 and CNL80 Repair wiring
1) Start engine.
1) Turn starting (female) (31, or between harness,
2) Disconnect 2
I switch OFF. replace, or
L-t
CNEl9. CNL80 (female) (6) - CNLRS
Is voltage between replace relay
2) Disconnect (2) -chassis ground, or
CNE19 (female) (1)
CNL18. defective dust indicator
NO and chassis
ground normal?
1) Turn starting
Irelay
switch ON.
Repair wiring
2) Disconnect
harness,
CNEl9.
replace, or
3120-30V
replace relay
+24
A
CNLR4 CNERl CNE19 Dust indicator
CNL.R5
20-310
0
TROUBLESHOOTING K-6
K-6 CAUTION items are flashing but alarm buzzer does not sound
Ir The buzzer does not sound for CHARGE or ENGINE OIL LEVEL.
* Before carrying out troubleshooting, check that all the related connectors are properly inserted.
t Always connect any disconnected connectors before going on the next step.
Cause I Remedy
+24V
CNFS2 CNL42 Alarm buzzer
Maintenance monitor /
CNL19
Main monitor
CNLOG
TDWW322
20-311
m
TROUBLESHOOTING K-7
Cause Remedy
+24V
CNFS2 CNL42 Alarm buzzer
Maintenance monitor
CNL19 CNL43
Main monitor
20-3 12
0
TROUBLESHOOTING K-8
K-8 CAUTION items are flashing but warning lamp (CHECK lamp,
CAUTION lamp) does not light up
* Before carrying out troubleshooting, check that there are no blown lamp bulbs.
1: Before carrying out troubleshooting, check that all the related connectors are properly inserted.
* Always connect any disconnected connectors before going on the next step.
Remedy
?eplace
TDW00324
20-313
ii7
TROUBLESHOOTING K-S
Remedy
TOW00324
20-314
0
TROUBLESHOOTING K-10
K-10 Night lighting does not light up when lamp switch is turned ON
(only lighting of maintenance monitor does not light up)
* Before carrying out troubleshooting, check that there are no blown lamp bulbs.
Ir Before carrying out troubleshooting, check that all the related connectors are properly inserted.
* Always connect any disconnected connectors before going on the next step.
Cause Remedy
Fuse box
Lighting
CNL21 CNFS2
+24V
CNL02 Lamp switch
t 3
TDW00326
20-315
m
TROUBLESHOOTING K-l 1
K-11 Night lighting lights up even when lamp switch is OFF, night
lighting stays lighted up
* Before carrying out troubleshooting, check that all the related connectors are properly inserted.
* Always connect any disconnected connectors before going on the next step.
Cause Remedy
Fuse box
Lighting
CNL21 CNFS2
I +24v
CNL02 Lamp switch
20-316
0
TROUBLESHOOTING K-12, K-13
Remedy
YES
Defective service meter Replace
I
Is voltage
1
YES
IDefective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
harness between CNL22
Repair wiring
harness or
between CNL22
3 I (female) (2) - CNLR4 (61 -
replace
(female) (2) and Is there continuity CNERl (9) -alternator
(1) normal? YES between CNL22 terminal R
(female) (1) and
1)20-30V 2 Defective contact. or
- chassis ground?
2) Start engine. P disconnection in wiring Repair wiring
Is voltage between
31 Disconnect alternator terminal 1) Turn starting harness between CNL22 harness or
CNL22. NO R and chassis - switch OFF. (female) (1) - CNLR5 (2) - replace
ground normal? 2) Disconnect chassis ground
CNL22.
1)20-30V
2) Start engine. NO/ Defective alternator Replace
_
Cause Remedy
* -
1 YES
Defective service meter Replace
Is voltage
between CNL22 Defective alternator, or
(female) (2) and contact of wiring harness Replace
(1) normal? between CNL22 (female) alternator, or
NO (2) - CNLR4 (6) - CNERl repair, replace
l)O-4v
(9) alternator terminal R wiring harness
2) Turn starting
with +24V
switch ON.
3) Disconnect
CNL22.
Starting motor
Service meter
Alternator
TDW00328
20-3 17
(3
TROUBLESHOOTING K-14
r----i
Does fuel gauge _ Is there continuity
3 YES Iefective maintenance
nonitor module
Replace
YES
Defective fuel sensor Replace
1
Fuel sensor
.a
20-318
0
TROUBLESHOOTING K-14
1
Do all display 3 YES Defeake maintenance
areas on engine Replace
Is there continuity monitor module
water temperature
YES between CNL18 Defective contact, or
gauge go out?
(female) (4) and disconnection in wiring
2 Repair wiring
1) Disconnect - chassis ground? harness between CNEOG
CNEOG. Is there continuity - P harness or
1) Turn starting NO (female) (1) - CNERl (6) -
2) Connect short _ between CNEOG replace
- switch OFF. CNLR4 Ill- CNLl8
connector to NO (female) (2) and
2) Connect short (female) (4)
CNEOG (female). chassis ground?
connector to
31 Turn starting 1) Turn starting CNEOG (female).
switch ON. switch OFF. 31 Disconnect Defective contact, or
2) Disconnect CNL18. disconnection in wiring Repair wiring
CNEOG. harness between CNEOG harness or
NO (female) (2) - CNERl (7) - replace
chassis ground
3 I
20-319
0
TROUBLESHOOTING K-14
temperature gauge
display minimum
1) Disconnect
CNT07.
2) Turn starting
switch ON.
I
hIO
Is there continuity
between CNT07
(female) (1) and
chassis ground?
1) Turn starting
switch OFF.
2 YES
I
NO
Contact of chassis grounc
with wiring harness
between CNT07 (female)
(1) - CNTLP (4) - CNL18
(female) (5)
Defective maintenance
monitor module
Repair wiring
harness or
replace
Replace
2) Disconnect
CNT07.
E 3
CNLR4
TDW00331
20-320
0
TROUBLESHOOTING OF ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
(E MODE)
,
E-12 Kick-down switch is actuated by mistake when traveling in 2nd ....................................... .20-392
TROUBLESHOOTING E-l
1) Turn starting
1) Turn starting
switch ON.
switch ON. VO
2) Check voltage
between chassis
and both
;
Ibanery relay?
I
terminals
YES
r
connected by
i 1) Starting switch thick cable.
ON H OFF. 6I
I Is voltaae 20 - 3ov
1
motor terminal
(El and chassis?
1) Turn starting
switch OFF. 1) Turn starting
switch ON.
1 1
L
NO
between CNE13
(female) (1) and
chassis 20 - 30 V?
1) Disconnect
CNE13. L
2) Directional NI3
lever: Neutral
3) Turn starting
switch to
START. Go to A on next page
\10
20-352
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-l
I Cause Remedy
Defective contact, or
disconnection in cable ifter inspection
between battery relay and epair or replao
starting motor
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
harness between starting
switch terminal BR - CNLO!3
YES (2) - CNLR4 (9) - CNROJ After inspectior
7 (diode) - CNRl2 (female). epair or replac
Is voltage between or defective contact, or
starting switch disconnection in wiring
terminal BR and harness between CNRl3
chassis 20 - 30 V? and chassis ground
Defective contact, or
Wer inspectior
- disconnection in starting
,epair or replac
* motor ground cable
20-353
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-l
ES
YE between CNL57
YES
(female) (5) and
chassis 20 - 30 V? YES Is voltage between
Is voltage
between CNL57 a YES
(female) (1)and
Is voltage
(2) 20 - 30 V?
I YES between CNL04
1)Disconnect (3) and chassis 20
CNL57. - 30 V?
2) Directional lever:
1) Connect T- NO
Neutral
7 adapter to
3) Turn starting 9 CNL04.
switch to START. Is voltage
2) Directional lever:
YE between CNL04
- Neutral
(female) (1) and
3) Turn starting
chassis 20 - 30 V?
switch ON.
1) Disconnect
CNL04. 9 YES
2) Turn starting
switch ON. Is actuating
Is there continuity - sound heard from -
between CNL57 NO battery relay? GotoBon
(female) (2) and
w previous
1) Starting switch NO page
1) Turn starting ON e OFF.
switch OFF.
2) Disconnect
CNL57.
20-354
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-l
Cause Remedy
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
harness between CNL57 After inspection,
(female) (3) - CNLR4 (8) - repair or replace
CNROl, 02 (diode) - CNERl
(lo)-CNE13 (female) (1)
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
After inspection,
harness between starting
repair or replace
switch terminal C - CNLOS
(3) - CNL57 (female) (5)
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
harness between startino
switch terminal 8 - CNLi9 After inspection,
(1) - CNFS3 (4) -fuse - repair or replace
CNFS3 (6) - CNLR5 (1) -
CNR17 - slow blow fuse
30A - battery relay
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
After inspection,
harness between CNLOI
repair or replace
(female) (3) and CNL57
(female) (1)
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
harness between battery
YES After inspection,
relay - slow blow fuse 8OP
repair or replace
- CNR15 - CNLRG (1) -
10
CNFSl (2) -fuse - CNFS2
Is voltage between (8) - CNL04 (female) (1)
both battery relay
terminals and * If answer is NO for both
chassis 20 - 30 V? terminals: Defective
contact or disconnection
1) Turn starting
in wiring harness betweel After inspection,
switch ON.
battery and battery relay repair or replace
2) Check voltage NO
- If answer is NO for one
between chassis
terminal: Defective batter
and both
relay
terminals
connected by Defective contact, or
thick cable. disconnection in wiring
After inspection,
harness between CNL57
repair or replace
(female) (2) and chassis
ground
TROUBLESHOOTING E-l
Yf ES
YES
I
ES
3
I 1 1) Connect T-
1) Turn starting adapter to
S
switch ON * CNEOS.
OFF and check 2) Turn starting
visually. switch ON.
h 6
1) Replace engine
stop relay (female) (2) and
fCNL62) with
stop lamp relay
between CNEOB (CNL53). 1) Turn starting
2) Turn starting Is voltage switch OFF.
H
switch ON * between CNL62 2) Disconnect
OFF and check h (female) (1) and CNL62.
11 Turn starting
switch OFF. visually. chassis 20 - 3OV?
2) Disconnect 1) Disconnect
CNE03. CNL62.
2) Turn starting
switch ON.
NO
N0
20-356
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-l
Cause Remedy
_i
Defective adjustment of
wire between engine stop Adjust
motor and lever
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
After inspection,
harness between CNL62
repair or replace
(female) (2) and chassis
ground
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
After inspection,
harness between CNL62
repair or replace
(female) (1) and CNLOS
(female) (2)
~~~~~~‘bpr
After inspection,
CNF2 (female) (11) - CNLF repair or replace
(3) - CNER2 (1) - CNE03
(female) (4)
20-357
a
TROUBLESHOOTING E-2 E-3
Defective adjustment
YES between fuel shutoff Adjust
solenoid and injectior
PumP
1
DoestudsMoff
solenoki F.S.SJ Defective contact After inspection
Work? or disconnection in repair or replace
wire harness
24 volts 2
4
1) lmt start
rwltch
‘OK e-D DFF Doestin ‘A.of F.SS.
and chedt vkudly ConnKtof have 24r
wtth start switch ON
and Or with switch NO Defective contact After inspection
NO OFF?
or disconnection in repair or replace
Defective fuel
shutoff solenoid Replace
20-358
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-4
Cause Remedy
(al Parking brake has no effect when parking brake switch is
turned ON (parking)
Is problem II
removed when Contact of wiring harness
YES After inspectiol
CNLOl is at CNLOl (female) (2) end
2 epair or replac
disconnected? snd (3) end
- Is there continuity
1) Disconnect
L between CNLOl
CNLOl.
NO (female) (2) and 3 YES Defective parking brake
2) Start engine. seplace
(3)? solenoid
(Charge brake _ Is voltage between
oil pressure) 1) Disconnect _ CNTOS (female) (1)
CNLOl. ND and chassis
approx. OV? Contact of wiring harness
2) Turn starting Wter inspectiol
st CNLOl (female) (2) end
switch OFF. 1) Connect NO epair or replac
snd (1) end
3) Disconnect T-adapter to
CNL58. CNTOB.
4) Disconnect 2) Start engine.
CNL59. (Charge brake oil
pressure)
3) Turn parking
brake switch ON.
x -
YES Iefective emergency
leplace
11 xake switch CNRPl
Iefective emergency
ieplace
Jrake switch CNR22
~
20-359
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-5
1 i Disconnect NO
CNTOS.
2) Turn starting
switch OFF.
YI
removed when
between CNT05
(female) (1) and
1) Replace parking
1) Connect brake safety
T-adapter to relay (CNL59)
CNT05. with stop lamp
2) Start engine. relay fCNL53).
(Charge brake 2) Start engine.
oil pressure) (Charge brake oil
pressure) removed when
n short connector is
1) Connect short
connector to YES
CNRPO (female)
3
and CNR21
Is continuity of
I I
(female).
CNLOl (male) 2) Stan engine.
L 7
NIOI (l)(2)(3) as shown (Charge brake
in Table l?
1) Disconnect
oil pressure)
I
Is there continuity
YES between CNL59
I;Heyale) (1) and
I
1
CNLOl.
2) Turn starting
switch OFF. 6 1) Disconnect
CNL59.
‘I
3) Operate parking
brake switch 2) Turn starting
between CNL59
ON/OFF. switch OFF.
bJO (female) (5) and
chassis 20 - 3OV?
1) Disconnect
CNL59.
2) Turn starting
switch ON.
Table 1
Operation Between terminal (2) - (3) Between terminal (1) - (3)
ON (parking) No continuity Continuity
OFF (travel) Continuity No continuity
20-360
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-5
Cause Remedy
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring Wer inspectior
harness between CNTOB .epair or replac
(female) (2) and chassis
Defective emergency
brake switch qeplace
Defective contact, or
disoonnection in wiring
YES 4fter inspectior
11 harness between CNR20
Fepair or replac
(female) (2) and CNT05
(female) (1)
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring After inspectior
harness between CNL59 repair or replac
(1) and CNL59 (3)
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
After inspectior
harness between CNL59
repair or replac
(female) (5) - CNFSZ (7) -
fuse
20-361
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-6, E-7
Cause Remedy
H
removed when YES defective parking brake
Xeolace
relay is replaced? 21 witch
1) Replace parking
removed when
1 is II rontact of wiring harness
3 ifter inspection
(CNL59) with letween CNL59 (5) and
disconnected? epair or replacf
stop lamp relay 3)(l) (female8
1) Disconnect between CNL59
(CNL53).
2) Start engine. Contact of wiring harness
(Charge brake 2) Start engine. After inspection
letween CNLOl (1) and (2
oil pressure) (Charge brake 1) Disconnect ,epair or replacf
female)
3) Turn starting oil pressure) CNL59.
switch ON. 3) Turn starting 2) Turn starting
switch ON. switch OFF. 0”
3) Turn parking
brake switch
k
OFF. 4
20-362
CC
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
Remedy
:o to E-8(a)
Go to E-8(b)
Go to E-8(c)
chassis. I
Go to E-8(e)
1)Disconnect
CNTOJ and
CNT04. If condition is as shown in
2) Turn starting Table 2 - 8 Go to E-8(f)
Contact in speed circuit
switch ON. If condition is as shown in
3) Turn parking Table 2 - 9 (transmission is
switch ON - always in 4th)
1Contact in 4th circuit Go to E-8(g)
OFF.
4) Operate speed If condition is as shown in
and in reverse? lever with Table 3 or Table 4 - 1
(REVERSE is normal) Problem in FORWARD
directional lever Go to E-8(h)
circuit
1) Start engine. at FORWARD,
If condition is as shown in
2) Turn parking NEUTRAL, and Table 3 or Table 4 - 2
switch ON - REVERSE to (FORWARD is normal) Problem in REVERSE
‘ravels in only Go to E-8(i)
OFF. check condition. circuit
ORWARD or
3) Operate LEVERSE, or If condition is as shown in
directional lever Table 4 - 3 (does not travel Problem in common
in either direction) circuit for FORWARD and Go to E-8(j)
FORWARD *
REVERSE. REVERSE
_ If condition is as shown in
;zlMkaT,- 4 (REVERSE is
Contact in FORWARD
Go to E-8(k)
circuit
If condition is as shown in
1) Disconnect Table 4 - 5 (FORWARD is
CNTOl and normal) Contact in REVERSE
Go to E-8(1)
CNTOZ. circuit
If condition is as shown in
2) Turn starting
Table 4 - 6 (does not travel Problem in common
switch ON. in either direction)
circuit for FORWARD and Go to E-8(m)
3) Turn parking
switch ON 4 REVERSE
OFF.
4) Operate directional lever with speed lever in
all positions (1st to 4th) to check condition.
% Go to applicable item.
20-364
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
(H - L) (Speed)
-1
I 1 I 0 I l I 1 0 0
1210101 2 0 0
I3l.ld 3 0 0
4 0 0 4 0 0 4 0 0
Table 1 (normal) Table 2-l (abnormal) Table 2-2 (abnormal) Table 2-3 (abnormal)
I 1 I 0 I l I
I 2 I 0 I 0 I 1210101
I 3 I l I 0 II 3 I l I 0 I
4 0 0 4 0 0
Table 2-4 (abnormal) Table 2-5 (abnormal) Table 2-6 (abnormal)
4 0 0 4 0 a
Table 2-7 (abnormal) TabIs 2-8 (abnormal) Table 2-9 (abnormal) _
(F) (RI
FORWARD 0 0 I FORWARD/ . 1 0 1
REVERSE 0 0 I REVERSE I 0 I 0 I
Table 3 (normal) Table 4-l (abnormal) Table 4-2 (abnormal) Table 4-3 (abnormal)
FORWARD1 . 1 0 1
20-365
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
Cause I Remedy
0 : 20 - 30 v
0: 0 - 0.5 v
Between Between Between Between
CN04(5) - chassis CN04(6) - chassis CN04(7) - chassis CN04(8) - chassis
1 0 0 0 0
2 0 0 0 0
3 0 0 0 0
4 0 0 0 0
I
YES
- Defective H - L solenoid Replace
2
Is voltage
Defective contact, or
YES between CNT03
disconnection in wiring
(female) (1) and 3 YES After inspection.
harness between CNLOI
chassis 20 - 3OV? Is voltage repair or replace
(female) (7) - CNTLl (5) -
1) Disconnect between CNL04 CNTOJ (female) (1)
1
CNT03. NO (7) and chassis 20
Is there continuity 2) Turn starting - 3OV? Defective speed lever
between CNT03 _ Replace
switch ON. NO switch
1) Connect
(female) (2) and 3) Speed lever: 3rd T-adapter to
chassis?
CNL04.
1) Disconnect 2) Turn starting
CNT03. switch ON. Defective contact, or
2) Turn starting 3) Speed lever: 3rd disconnection in wiring
After inspection,
switch OFF. harness between CNT03
NO repair
(female) (2) and chassis
ground
20-366
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
YES
Defective speed solenoid Replace
2
Is voltage
Defective contact, or
YES between CNT04 _
disconnection in wiring
(female) (1) and 3 YES After inspection
harness between CNL04
chassis 20 - 30 V? , repair or replact
1 Is voltage (female) (5) - CNTLl (6) -
- 1) Disconnect _ between CNL04 _ CNT04 (female) (1)
Is there continuity NO (5) and chassis 20
CNT04.
between CNTOI -3OV?
- 2) Turn starting Defective speed lever
(female) (2) and Replace
switch ON. 1) Connect NO switch
chassis?
3) Speed lever: 1st T-adapter to CNL04.
1) Disconnect Defective contact, or
2) Turn starting switch ON.
CNT04. disconnection in wiring
I
3) Speed lever: 1st After inspection
2) Turn starting 7harness between CNTOI repair or replace
switch OFF. NO (female) (2) and chassis
ground
20-367
.o
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
YES
1) Disconnect
CNTOJ.
2) Disconnect
CNTLl.
3) Turn starting
between CNTLl YES
switch ON.
1) Turn starting
switch OFF.
2) Disconnect
CNT03. )
3) Disconnect
I 1
between CNTLl
CNTLl.
1) Disconnect
CNTLI.
2) Disconnect 4
CNL04.
!---I
Is there continuity
3) Turn starting
between CNTLl
switch ON.
NO (mate) (5) and
(3)(4)(6)?
1) Turn starting
YES
switch OFF.
2) Disconnect
CNTLl.
3) Disconnect Is there continuity
CNL04. between CNLOI
1) Turn starting
switch OFF.
2) Disconnect r10
CNTLl.
3) Disconnect
CNL04.
4) Disconnect
CNL66.
20-368
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
I Cause Remedy
Abnormal contact of
wiring harness between
Jter inspectior
CNT03 (female) (1) and
zpair or replac
CNTLl (female) (5) with
+24V wiring harness
&her inspectior
epair or replac
eplace
20-369
a
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
between CNT04
‘ES
(female) (1) and
chassis 20 - 30 V?
1) Disconnect
CNT04.
2) Disconnect
CNTLl. 2
3) Turn starting
I
Is there continuity
switch ON. between CNTLl
N (female) (6) and
(3)(4)(5)? I
1) Turn starting
switch OFF.
2) Disconnect
CNT04.
3) Disconnect
CNTLl. between CNTLl YES
chassis 20 - 30 V?
1) Disconnect
CNTLl.
21 Disconnect
CNL68. 4
3) Disconnect Is there continuity
CNLOI. between CNTLl
4) Turn starting N 0 (male) (6) and
switch ON. 4 (3)(4)(5)? I
1) Turn starting YES
switch OFF.
2) Disconnect
5 I
H
CNTLl.
3) Disconnect Is there continuity
CNL68. between CNLO4
4) Disconnect h (female) (5) and
CNLO4. (l)(2)(3)(4)(6)?
1) Turn starting
switch OFF.
2) Disconnect NO
CNTLl.
3) Disconnect
CNL68.
4) Disconnect
CNL04.
5) Disconnect
CNL66.
20-370
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
Cause
Abnormal contact of
wiring harness between
After inspection,
CNT04 (female) (1) and
repair or replace
CNTLl (female) (6) with
+24V wiring harness
Abnormal contact of
I wiring harness between
I
CNTL? (male) (6) and i After inspection,
CNL04 (female) (5). CNL68 1repair or replace
(female) (4) with +24V I
wiring harness
After inspection,
repair or replace
20-371
8
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
Cause Remedy
Abnormal contact of
CNLOQ (female) (8) - CN37
1 YES
- (female) (2). CN38 (female) ~~ri~!$~c~
Is voltage (2) with +24V wiring
between CNL04 _ harness
(female) (8) and
chassis 20 - 3OV? Defective speed lever
Replace
1) Disconnect F\10 switch
CNLO4.
2) Turn starting
switch ON.
20-372
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
2 YES
between CNTOl
(female) (2) and I
chassis? I
I) Disconnect NO
CNTOl.
!) Turn starting
switch OFF. ‘ES
between CNTOl
(female) (1) and
chassis 20 - 3OV?
7 YES
1) Disconnect Is voltage
CNTOl. YES between CNL~~
2) Turn starting (female) (5) and
switch ON. 6 chassis 20 - 3OV?
3) Turn parking
Is problem Is there continuity NO
switch ON * I 1) Disconnect
removed when 1 YE between CNL66 _ CNL66.
OFF.
(female) (6) and 2) Turn starting
4) Directional
chassis? switch ON.
lever: 5
FORWARD
1)Replace 1) Disconnect
3) Directional
FORWARD lever: FORWARD
CNL66.
solenoid relay
2) Turn starting NO
(CNL66) with (female) (2) and 8
switch OFF.
REVERSE z
solenoid relay
Lo
Nhgj “f$!!;;;g
(CNL67). 4
2) Start engine.
3) Turn parking
switch ON -
OFF.
4) Directional
lever:
FORWARD
switch ON. NO
3) Turn parking
switch ON *
OFF.
20-374
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
Cause Remedy
Ion
act
(female) (5)
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring After inspection
harness between CNL66 I repair or replace
(female) (6) and chassis
Defective contact. or
IDefective contact. or I
20-375
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
2 YES
Is there continuity
YE between CNT02
(female) (2) and
chassis?
1) Disconnect NO
CNT02.
2) Turn starting
1 switch OFF. YES
between CNT02
(female) (1) and
chassis 20 - 30 V? 7 YES
11 Disconnect
CNTOL. YE
2) Turn starting BH
switch ON.
6
3) Turn parking
1) Disconnect NO
switch ON * Is there continuity
removed when CNL67.
OFF.
N relay is replaced? 2) Turn starting
4) Directional (female) (6) and
switch ON.
lever: REVERSE ’
1) Reolace 3) Directional
1) Disconnect lever: REVERSE
REVERSE
CNL67.
solenoid relay YE between CNL67
2) Turn starting
tCNL67) with (female) (2) and
switch OFF.
FORWARD
solenoid relay
1) Disconnect
(CNL66).
CNL67.
2) Start engine.
between CNL67 2) Turn starting
3) Turn parking NO
switch OFF.
switch ON *
OFF.
4) Directional 1) Disconnect
lever: REVERSE CNL67.
2) Turn starting
switch ON. NO
3) Turn parking
switch ON +
OFF.
20-376
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
I Cause Remedy I
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring After inspection,
harness between CNT02 repair or replace
(female) (2) and chassis
Replace
Replace
After inspection,
repair or replace
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring After inspection,
harness between CNL67 repair or replace
(female) (6) and chassis
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
After inspection,
harness between CNL67
repair or replace
(female) (2) - CNTLl (4) -
CNTOZ (female) (1)
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
After inspection,
harness between CNL66
repair or replace -
(female) (1) and CNL67
(female) (1)
20-377
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
YES
2
Is voltage
YEI between CNLOI
(21, (4) -chassis as 3 YES
shown in table? Is voltage
1)Connect between CNL04
T-adapter to NO (female) (1) and
CNL04. chassis 20 - 30 V?
2) Turn starting 1) Disconnect NO
switch ON. CNL04.
3) Directional 2) Turn starting
lever: F + N + R
r
YES
5,
removed when
1) Replace
neutralizer relay
(CNL58) with
stop lamp relay chassis?
(CNL53).
1) Disconnect
2) Start engine. CNL58.
between CNL58 ‘/
2) Turn starting NO
switch OFF.
1) Disconnect
CNL58.
2) Turn starting
switch ON.
3) Turn parking
brake switch ON
- OFF.
0 : 20 - 30 v
0: 0 - 0.5 v
Between Between
CN04(2) - chassis CN04(4) - chassis
F 0 0
N 0 0
R 0 0
20-378
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
I Cause I Remedy
1 Defective contact. or I
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
harness between CNL65
After inspectior
. (female) (3) and CNLlZ
repair or replac
(female) (1). or between
CNLl2 (female) (2) and
CNL65 (female) (5)
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
harness between CNL58
(female) (5) and CNLl2 After inspectior
(female) (l), or between repair or replac
CNLl2 (female) (2) -
CNL66 (female) (1). CNL67
(female) (1)
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
YES
1 YES
t
removed when
1) Replace
FORWARD relay
(CNL66) with F
working lamp ‘ES
relay (CNLGO). N
2) Start engine.
3) Turn parking
1) Disconnect
brake switch ON
CNTOl.
- OFF.
2) Disconnect
4) Directional 3
CNTLl.
lever: Is there continuity
3) Turn starting
FORWARD YES
switch ON. between CNTLl
hIO (female) (3) and
1) Turn starting
switch OFF.
2) Disconnect
CNTOl. 4
3) Disconnect ‘ES
CNTLl. between CNTLl
N I
chassis 20 - 30 V?
1) Disconnect
CNTLl.
2) Disconnect
CNL66.
3) Turn starting
I
Is there continuity
switc :h ON.
_
1 between CNTLl
NC (male1 (3) and
(4)(5)(6)? t
r
1) Turn starting
YES
switch OFF.
2) Disconnect
CNTLl. 6
3) Disconnect
Is there continuity
CNL66.
between CNL04
NO
4 (female) (2) and
(l)(3)(4)(5)(6)(7)(8)?
1) Turn starting
switch OFF.
21 Disconnect ‘1
CNL66. NO
3) Disconnect
CNL04.
20-380
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
Cause Remedy
wiring harness
p;ilv;;;zmission Replace
20-381
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
YES
removed when
relay is replaced?
1) Replace
REVERSE relay
fCNL67) with F
working lamp YES
relay (CNL60). N
2) Start engine.
3) Turn parking
1) Disconnect
brake switch ON
CNTOZ.
- OFF.
2) Disconnect
4) Directional 3
CNTLl.
lever: REVERSE Is there continuity
3) Turn starting
YES
switch ON. between CNTLl
h
1) Turn starting
switch OFF.
2) Disconnect
4
CNTOZ.
3) Disconnect
ES
CNTLl.
Nb!j;2%;7 1
1) Disconnect
CNTLl.
2) Disconnect
CNL67.
3) Turn starting
switch ON. between CNTLl
1) Turn starting
switch OFF.-
2) Disconnect
CNTLl.
6
3) Disconnect
CNL67.
between CNL04
1 (female) (4) and
(l)(2)(3)(5)(6)(7)(6)?
1) Turn starting
switch OFF.
2) Disconnect
CNL67.
3) Disconnect
CNLOP.
20-382
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-8
Cause Remedy
--i
Defective REVERSE relay Replace
Abnormal contact of
wiring harness between
After inspection,
CNTOZ (female) (1) and
repair or replace
CNTLl (female) (4) with
+24V wiring harness
Abnormal contact of
wiring harness between
After insoection.1
CNTLl (female) (4) and
repair or’replace
CNL67 (female) (2) with
+24V wiring harness
Replace
20-383
TROUBLESHOOTING E-9
20-384
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-9
Y
removed when
relay is replaced?
1) Replace kick-
down relay
tCNL68) with
REVERSE
r
solenoid relay 3 YES
L
(CNL67).
2) Start engine. Is prob’am
removed when
NC relay is replaced?
1) Replace
FORWARD (female) (1) and
1 solenoid relay CNL66 (female) (4)?
fCNL66) with
Is there continuity 5 1) Disconnect
REVERSE
between CNLl5 CNL15 and
l--l
solenoid relay Is there continuity
(male) (1) and CNL66.
fCNL67). YI between CNL68
2) Turn starting L
2) Start engine. (female) (5) and
switch OFF. NO
1) Disconnect CNL15 (female) f2)?
CNL15.
2) Press kick-down 4 1) Disconnect
switch. CNL68 and
Is there continuity
3) Turn starting CNL15.
2) Turn starting
switch OFF. N VO
switch OFF.
1) Disconnect
CNL68.
2) Turn starting
switch OFF.
IO
NO
20-386
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-S
Cause Remedy
Defective FORWARD
Replace
solenoid relay
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
YES After inspection
a I harness between CNL68
repair or replacl
1
(female) (4) and CNL04
YE (female) (5)
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
After inspectior
harness between CNL68
NO repair or replacs
CNL68. (female) (3) and CNL04
2) Speed lever:2nd (female) (6)
3) Turn starting
Defective contact, or
switch ON.
disconnection in wiring
1) Disconnect 9 YES After inspectior
harness between CNL66
CNL66. Is voltage repair or replacs
(female) (3) and CNLO4
2) Speed lever: between CNLO4 (female) (6)
2nd N (6) and chassis 20
3) Turn starting - 3OV? Defective speed lever
II Replace
switch ON. switch
1 I Connect NO
T-adapter to CNL04.
2) Speed lever: 2nd Defective contact, or
3) Turn starting switch ON. disconnection in wiring
After inspection
harness between CNLl5
repair or replao
(female) (1) and CNL66
(female) (4)
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
After inspection
harness between CNL68
repair or replacl
(female) (5) and CNL15
(female) (2)
Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
After inspectior
harness between CNL68
repair or replac
(female) (6) and chassis
ground
Defective kick-down
Replace
switch
20-387
a
TROUBLESHOOTING E-10. E-11
Cause Remedy
1 YES
Defective kick-down relay Replace
Is problem Defective contact, or
removed when - disconnection in wiring
relay is replaced? After
harness between CNL66
inspection,
(female) (4) - CNL68
1) Replace kick- NO repair or
(female) (1) or CNL68
down relay replace
(femalle) (2) - CNL68
(CNL68) with (female) (5)
REVERSE
solenoid relay
(CNL67).
2) Start engine.
I Cause
20-388
a
TROUBLESHOOTING E-II
(b1 Not canceled even when speed lever is moved from 2nd to other position (becomes 4th)
YES
YES
I
1) Turn starting
switch OFF. ES
between CNL04
2) Disconnect
CNL04.
3) Disconnect
CNL66. 1) Turn starting
switch OFF.
2) Disconnect between CNL66 YES
CNLOI. F
3) Disconnect
CNL66.
1) Disconnect 4
CN L66.
2) Disconnect
between CNL66
CNL04. YES
h4
3) Turn starting
switch ON.
1) Disconnect 5
8
CNL66.
Is voltage
2
2) Disconnect
CNL68.
between CNL68
-
3 5
NO (female) (2) and
3) Disconnect
chassis 20 - 30 V?
CNLlS. 6
4) Turn starting 1) Disconnect
CNL68. Is there continuity
switch ON.
between CNL04
2) Disconnect
NO (female) (1) and
CNL15.
CNLO4 (female) (5)?
3) Turn starting
switch ON. - 1) Turn starting
switch OFF.
2) Disconnect f,
CNLOI.
T-
3) Disconnect
CNFTl.
20-390
0
TROUBLESHOOTING E-11
I Cause Remedy
After inspection
repair or replact
Abnormal contact of
wiring harness between
After inspection
CNL04 (female) (2) (61, or
repair or replact
defective speed lever
switch
Abnormal contact of
wiring harness between After inspection
CNLOO (6) and CNL66 (3) repair or replace
with +24V wiring harness
Abnormal contact of
After inspection
repair or replace
(female) (1) wit.h +i4V
wiring harness
1Abnormal contact of
After inspection
I repair or replao
(female) (2) with +24V
wiring harness
After inspection
/ %r$rE~~;;n
repair or replace
Abnormal contact of
wiring harness between
CNLO4 (female) (5) -
CNL68 (female) (4). CN37 1After inspection
(female) (l), CNTLl (male) repair or reptact
(6) with +24V wiring
harness, or defective
speed lever switch
Abnormal contact of
1) Disconnect wiring harness between After inspection
CNL68. NO CNTLl (6) and CNT04 (1) repair or replace
2) Disconnect with +24V wiring harness
CNTLl.
3) Disconnect
CNLOI.
4) Starting switch
ON.
TROUBLESHOOTING E-12
Cause Remedy
20-392
0
TROUBLESHOOTING OF HYDRAULIC AND ME-
CHANICAL SYSTEM (CHASSIS RELATED)
(T MODE)
POWER TRAIN
T- 1 Machine does not start.. ........................................................................................................... 20-402
T- 2 Travel speed is slow, thrusting power is weak, lacks power on slopes ............................ 20-404
T- 3 Excessive shock when starting machine or shifting gear.. .................................................. .20-406
T- 4 Excessive time lag when starting machine or shifting gear ............................................... .20-407
T- 5 Torque converter oil temperature is high .............................................................................. 20-408
STEERING SYSTEM
T- 6 Steering does not turn .............................................................................................................. 20-409
T- 7 Steering wheel is heavy ........................................................................................................... 20-410
T- 8 Steering wheel wobbles or there is excessive shock ............................................................ 20-411
T- 9 Machine steers to one side when traveling ........................................................................... 20-411
T-10 Turning radius to left and right is different ........................... ................................................ 20-411
BRAKE SYSTEM
T-II Brakes do not work or braking effect is poor ........................................................................ 20-412
T-12 Brakes are not released or brakes drag.. ................................................................................ 20-413
2 T-13 Parking brake is not released or brake drags ........................................................................ 20-414
:
5
WORK EQUIPMENT
T-14 Boom does not rise .................................................................................................................. 20-415
T-15 Boom movement is slow or boom lacks lifting power.. ...................................................... .20-416
T-16 When boom is raised, it moves slowly at a certain height.. ............................................... .20-417
T-17 Bucket cannot be pushed with boom cylinder (bucket floats) ............................................ .20-417
T-18 Excessive hydraulic drift of boom ........................................................................................... 20-417
T-19 Boom shakes during operation ............................................................................................... 20-417
T-20 Boom drops momentarily when control lever is operated from HOLD to RAISE ............ 20-418
T-2 1 Bucket does not tilt back .......................................................................................................... 20-419
T-22 Bucket movement is slow or tilt-back lacks power .............................................................. .20-420
T-23 Bucket movement becomes slow during tilt-back operation .............................................. .20-421
T-24 Bucket cannot be pushed with bucket cylinder ..................................................................... 20-421
T-25 Excessive hydraulic drift of bucket.. ........................................................................................ 20-421
T-26 Bucket shakes during loading operation ................................................................................ 20-422
T-27 Bucket dumps momentarily when control lever is operated from HOLD to TILT.. .......... 20-422
T-28 Boom, bucket control levers are heavy or do not move smoothly.. .................................. .20-423
20-401
a
TROUBLESHOOTING T-l
POWER TRAIN
T-l Machine does not start
7 Transmission clutch pressure does not rise in any speed range 000 00 0
20-402
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-l
20-403
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-2
a/b/c/d/e/ f lg /
Remedy A A A a n
No. Problems xxxxxx x
1 Abnormality in all transmission ranges OOGOO 0
Transmission
20-404
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-2
20-405
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-3
20-406
TROUBLESHOOTING T-4
20-407
@
TROUBLESHOOTING T-5
Transmission
clutch pressure
20-408
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-6
STEERING SYSTEM
* There is a close relationship between the steering circuit and work equipment circuit, so if any
abnormality is felt in the steering, check also the operating condition of the work equipment.
20-409
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-7
* There is a close relationship between the steering circuit and work equipment circuit, so if any
abnormality is felt in the steering, check also the operating condition of the work equipment.
20-4 10
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-8, T-9, T-10
20-411
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-11
BRAKE SYSTEM
T-11 Brakes do not work or braking effect is poor
Ask the operator the following questions.
. Did the problem suddenly start?
Yes = Brake equipment broken
l Did the problem gradually appear?
Yes = Deterioration of seal, wear of
lining, disc
Jack up 4 wheels and set axles on stand. In Fl, when brakes are
Air can be seen flowing out when air is bled from brake circuit.
Returns to normal after air is bled.
20-412
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-12
When brake pedal is released and oil is bled from air bleeder,
2 0
circuit pressure goes down and brake is released I I I I
Jack up 4 wheels and set axles on stand. When engine is stopped
3 and parking brake is released, certain wheels are heavy when they 00
are rotated by hand
20-4 13
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-13
I
I I
/a /b/c
I , I
/d I
/e /f
I
f
Remedy A A n A A A
No. Problems xxx xx
l When emergency parking brake switch is turned ON, parking brake is not released
In such a case, the probable cause is following.
a. Defective operaction of emergency parking brake cancel valve
b. Breakage in wiring harness in line for emergency parking brake cancel switch
c. Insufficient gas pressure in brake accumulator, damaged piston seal
20-414
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-14
WORK EQUIPMENT
T-14 Boom does not rise
Ask the operator the following questions.
. Did the problem suddenly start?
Yes = Equipment seized, damaged
Was there any abnormal noise
when this happened? (from
where?)
l Was there previously any symptom, such
as the speed becoming slow?
Yes = Wear of internal parts, dete-
rioration in spring
1 1 Bucket cannot be ooerated and boom cannot be raised lolololol 0 lol lolol I
2
Chassis can be raised with boom but boom cannot be raised, or
bucket can be operated but boom cannot be raised -- I I I I I I lol lol O I
Boom can be raised when there is no load but cannot be raised
3
when there is a load 101 loI I I I lol I I -
4 1 Abnormal noise comes from hvdraulic oumo lol lolol IIIII I
5 Excessive hydraulic drift of boom cylinder
I I I I I I I I I I I
When engine is running at full throttle, steering operation is too
6
light and fast
0
20-415
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-15
Bucket tilting power and speed are abnormal and boom lifting
1
speed is slow
00 0 0 0
Bucket tilting power and speed are normal but boom lifting speed
2 0 00
is slow
20-416
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-16. T-17, T-18, T-19
20-4 17
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-20
20-418
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-21
20-419
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-22
Boom lifting power and speed are abnormal and bucket tilt-back
1
power or speed are abnormal
0000 0 0
Boom lifting power and speed are normal but bucket tilt- back
2
power or speed are abnormal
0 00 0
gme IS runmng a
20-420
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-23, T-24, T-25
Cause
l Swelling or internal damage to bucket cylinder tube
. For other abnormalities when the bucket is operated, go to “T- 22 Bucket movement is slow or
tilt-back lacks power.”
Cause
Defective seating of safety valve (with suction valve) at bucket cylinder rod end of main control
valve
Oil leakage from bucket cylinder piston seal
Cause
l Oil leakage inside bucket cylinder
. Defective seating of safety valve (with suction valve) at bottom end
l Defective oil tightness of bucket spool
20-42 1
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-26, T-27
Cause
l Defective bucket cylinder piston seal
l Defective operation of safety valve (with suction valve) at bucket cylinder rod end. If any other
problem occurs at the same time, carry out troubleshooting according to the nature of the
problem.
Cause
. Defective seating of check valve for bucket spool in main control valve
20-422
0
TROUBLESHOOTING T-28
T-28 Boom, bucket control levers are heavy or do not move smoothly
Checking for abnormalities
l Check the values in the Standard Value
Table to check if the operating force of
the lever is actually excessive.
valve connection
20-423
0
TROUBLESHOOTING OF ECSS (ELECTRONICALLY
CONTROLLED SUSPENSION SYSTEM)
(D MODE)
Judgement Table for controller electrical system ...... .. ....... .... ......... ... ........ ...... ..... ......... .. ... ..... ... ...... 20-452
20-451
0
TROUBLESHOOTING JUDGEMENT TABLE FOR CONTROLLER ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Failure mode d0 dl d2 d3 d4
20-452
0
TROUBLESHOOTING D-l
Cause Remedy
L
-c 50 to Item (a)
-c ;o to Item (b)
-c So to Item Cc)
-c ;o to Item Cd)
Is there an
abnormality
display?
-c So to Item (e)
-c Go to Item (f) i
0
20-453
TROUBLESHOOTING D-l
,Ef-
2) DC resistance: (female) (21) - CNSAS (4) .epair or replace
chassis ground?
ZO-40R - CNAF4 (female) (1)
1) Disconnect
CNALl. P Disconnection in wiring
2) Disconnect harness between CNAFI
After inspection
CNAF4. (female) (2) - CNTLl (8) -
NO ,epair or replace
3) Connect short CNCLl (12) -chassis
CNAF4.
connector to ground
CNAF4 (female).
YES
I Defective controller Replace
’ I
IIs resistance
CNALl
between
(female1 (201 u YES
Defective solenoid
I normal? - II. 2
! continuity
YE’s:
1) Disconnect
CNALl.
2) DC resistance:
20-40D
h ,,s therecontinuit; v
Disconnection in wiring
harness between CNALl
(female) (20) - CNSAS (5)
- CNAFB (female) (1)
After inspectior
repair or replacm
1) Disconnect
CNALl. Disconnection in wiring
2) Disconnect NO0 harness between CNAFB
CNAFB. After inspectior
(female) (2) - CNTLl (8) -
3) Connect short NO repair or replac
CNAFS. CNCLl (12) -chassis
connector to ground
CNAF5 (female).
20-454
a
TROUBLESHOOTING D-l
I Cause Remedy
YES
Defective controller ieplace
1
Is resistance between
CNALl (female) (111 YES
and chassis ground Defective solenoid
WXmal? 2
1 Is there continuity
1) Disconnect Disconnection in wiring
between CNALl
CNALl. harness between CNALl Hter inspectior
~0 (female) (11) and
2) DC resistance: (female) (11) - CNSAS (6) epair or replacs
chassis ground?
20-40R P Is there continuity - CNAFG (female) (1)
1) Disconnect between CNAFG
CNALl. ~0 (female) (2) and Disconnection in wiring
2) Disconnect chassis ground? harness between CNAFG Vter inspectior
CNAFG.
1) Disconnect
- (female) (2) - CNTLl (8) - ,epair or replac
3) Connect short NO CNCLl (12) -chassis
CNAFG.
connector to ground
CNAFG (female).
YES
Defective speed sensor qeolace
1
Does error
display go off? 2 YES
[ Defective controller ?eplace
_ Is there continuity
1) Connect short _ between CNAL3
connector to NO (female) (4) and Disconnection in wiring
CNTOG (female). (12)? harness between CNAL3 After inspectior
2) Turn starting NO (4) - CNSAS (9) or CNAL3 .epair or replac
1) Disconnect
switch OFF - (12) - CNSAS (10) If any other
CNAW. :ontroller is
ON. 2) Connect short Ibnormal, check
connector to 111the wiring
CNTOG (female). Tarnesses for the
speedsensor
system)
20-455
0
TROUBLESHOOTING D-l
2 YES
lefective controller leplace
YES Is.continuity of
- wmng harnesses - lisconnection in wiring
normal? arness between CNALZ
1 rfter inspection
emale) and CNAL4 epair or replact
1)Disconnect NO nalel, or contact with
Is connection of
wiring harnesses - CNAL2. hassis ground
2) Is continuity between CNALP
normal?
(female) (1) - (4) and chassis lefective contact, or
ground as shown in table? isconnection in wiring
1) Disconnect
CNAL4. arness between CNALI rher inspection
I
2) Is continuity emale) and chassis epair or replace
NO
between CNAL4 (female) round, or contact with
(1),(2),f3),f5) - chassis ground as hassis ground
shown in table?
Table
YES
Iefective controller qeplace
, I
20-456
0
TROUBLESHOOTING D-l
)
Defective controller leplace
8 Does controller
Defective contact, or
2 disconnection in wiring
5 harness between CNALZ
1) Turn starting (female) (8) - CNSAS (7) - rher inspectior
switch ON. Is there continuity l)O-3v CNAF7 (female) (1). or epair or replac
NO
2) Load bucket. between CNAF7 2) Turn starting between CNAF7 (female)
switch ON. (2) - CNSAS (8) - CNAL4
3) Load bucket. (4) -chassis ground
1) Turn starting Defective pressure switch
switch ON. or defective chassis ieplace
2) Disconnect JO hydraulic system
CNAF7.
3) Load bucket.
20-457
TROUBLESHOOTING D-l
CNALI CNSAS
3
-3
@ CNAFG
Solenoid 3
(low
pressure)
CNTLl CNCLl
TDWOO349
@ 3 3
@ Speed H
a.
(g
a
20-458
a
TROUBLESHOOTING D-l
CNAL2 7
Network (-1
g. 3
CNLOG
@ ECSS operation switch
I
\\
TDW00352
@ c 3
B 3
CNAL4
TDW00353
20-459
0
TROUBLESHOOTING D-2
Cause Remedy
YES
Defective controller Iqeplace
, 1
TDWO0352
20-460
0
TROUBLESHOOTING D-3, D-4
Cause Remedy
I Go to Troubleshooting
1) Check LED
D-l (e)
disolav code. No
2jsee ’
STRUCTURE
AND FUNCTION
for details of the
codes.
1 YES
Defective controller Replace
IS resistance
between CNALP
(female1 (141 and - Defective contact, or
chassis ground disconnection in wiring
normal? After inspection
harness between CNAL2
NO repair or replace
1) Disconnect (female) (14) - CNSAS (3)
CNAL2. -speed solenoid
2)50-70R
To solenoid
TDW00355
20-46 1
3
TROUBLESHOOTING D-5
1 YES
i
Defective controller Replace
IS resistance
between CNALZ
(female) 113) and - Defective contact, or
chassis ground
disconnection in wiring
IlOVlUl? After inspectior
harness between CNALZ
NO repair or replacm
1) Disconnect (female) (13) - CNSAS (2)
CNALZ. -Hi/Lo solenoid
2)50-70R
To solenoid
TDW00355
20-462
0
TROUBLESHOOTING D-6, D-7
Cause Remedy
YES
Defective controller Replace
1 Defective contact, or
disconnection in wiring
3 YES After inspection
Is power source harness between CNALl
Is voltage between repair or replace
voltage normal? (female) (8). (18) - CNDPl
YES CNDPl (male) (1 t (female) (1)
1 2 and chassis
1)20-30V p ground normal?
Is there continuity Abnormality in fuse box Repair
2) Measure voltage between CNALl NO
- 1)20-30V
between CNAL~NG (female) (9). (19) - Defective contact, or
2) Disconnect
(81. (18) - (9). chassis ground?
CNDPl. disconnection in wiring
(19).
harness between CNALl After inspection
1)Disconnect
NO (female) (9). (19) - CNSAS repair or replace
CNALl.
(1 I - CNTLl (8) - CNCLl
(12) -chassis ground
CNALl CNDPI I
Fuse box
I I
@. 3 .a
1
TDW00359
D-7 ECSS is abnormal but main monitor does not give abnormality
display
I Cause Remedy
TROUBLESHOOTING
Eagle air conditioner/Heater)
Troubleshooting
Setup:
Controller on Temp. 60” F
Defrost “off, Fan on high
Abbreviations:
EC - Electric Condenser
(A) Problem - EO error message disolav on the controller:
1. Open EC power circuit Check the EC circuit breaker for a) Repair the wiring
I power, voltage, and continuity b) Replace open circuit breaker
2. Defective EC relay (circuit) Check for output voltage on the a) Repair the connections I wiring
yellow wire, at the relay coil. Check b) Replace the defective relay
the voltage and continuity across the
relay contacts.
3. Open EC voltage detection circuit Check for input voltage on the brown a) Repair the wiring or connector
wire. at the controller.
5. Defective controller Check for output voltage on the a) Replace the controller
vellow wire. at the controller.
1. Abnormal A/C refrigerant Check the refrigerant pressures with a) Check the condenser
pressure(s). gauges. operation for air and refrigerant
. Cool weather operation blockage
x
may cause low pressure High side greater than: b) Leak check system, repair the
short cycling 320.psig (Rl2), or 350 psig (Rl34a). leaks and recharge the system
Low side less than: c) Relocate the low pressure
3-6 psig. switch to the evaporator outlet
2. Opened compressor clutch Check for output voltage on the a) Repair the connections/wiring
circuit green wire at the compressor. Check b) Replace the defective
the wire connections. Check for switch(es) or the thermostat
continuity across the pressure c) Replace the defective
switch(es) and thermostat. Check the compressor clutch
continuity of the clutch solenoid to
ground.
3. Opened pressure switch Check for an input voltage on the tan a) Repair the connections/ wiring
detection circuit wire, at the controller.
4. Defective controller Check for output voltage on the a) Replace the controller
L
green wire, at the controller.
20-701
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING TROUBLESHOOTING - EAGLE AIR CONDITIONER
1. El error message may occur during charging when the low pressure switch (LPS) opens at 3 psig. The
suction side pressure must rise above 45 psig to reset the El error message.
2. When the system is fully charged, the El error message should not appear under normal operating
conditions.
3. In order to continue charging, by-pass the LPS, turn the controller “off then “on”, and set the controller to
60” F. This will reset the controller and force into the air conditioning mode.
4. If the LPS can’t be easily reached, disconnect the clutch wire at the compressor, and run a hot wire
directly to the compressor clutch solenoid. Take care not to short out the controller clutch circuit.
5. El error message may occur while charging, when the compressoris wired hot.
1. Opened heat solenoid circuit. Check for an output voltage on the a) Repair connections/wiring
Poor connection, loss of white wire, at the heat solenoid valve.
voltage. Check the solenoid continuity to
ground.
2. Defective heat solenoid or Check for coolant blockages in the a) Repair or replace the valve.
improper installation. heat solenoid valve and hoses. b) Reverse the coolant hoses to
Check the direction of coolant flow the valve.
(feel the hoses).
3. Defective controller Check for output voltage on the white a) Replace the controller
wire, at the controller.
20-702
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING TROUBLESHOOTING - EAGLE AIR CONDITIONER
(D) Problem - No display, the blower fan will not turn off, when the power is turned on.
1. Fan wires shorted to ground or Disconnect the controller from the a) Unground and repair the
vehicle chassis external harness, Individually check shorted wiring.
the continuity of the orange and black
fan wires to ground, in the external
harness.
(E) Problem - Compressor clutch will not engage, unless defrost button is pushed.
2. Ambient cab temperature too Set controller at 68-70” F, in a/c a) Verify if compressor clutch will
cool (below 60” F). mode. Warm-up ambient pull in or not.
temperature probe with fingers or b) If not go to step 3.’
heat gun.
3. Opened ambient cab Push, hold temp. Decrease/Increase a) If display reads 49F, at room
temperature probe (thermistor) buttons simultaneously. Display will temperature, replace thermistor.
read 40F if probe is defective. b) Repair connections/wiring.
Disconnect the controller, check for c) If 1OK ohms +/- 20%,
continuity across black probe leads. thermistor is good. If lOOK- M
Check resistance of thermistor. ohms, replace thermistor.
20-703
0
TESTING AND ADJUSTING TROUBLESHOOTING - EAGLE AIR CONDITIONER
Notes:
1. Wire colors may vary with installation. Refer to the wiring schematic.
2. For 24V controllers, resistor (Rl7) must be clipped and removed from the circuit board. (Refer to figure
below) If the resistor is not clipped on the 24V system, the controller display will light up, but the blower fan
will not turn on.
3. For air conditioning systems that do not use an electric condenser, the blue and brown wires must be
connected together, on the external harness. The brown wire must be connected to the battery voltage, or
the EO error message will result.
4. Care must be taken during installation, not to pinch or cut wiring from the controller. Shorted wiring may
result in damage to the controller.
5. Improper probe location of the evaporator coil thermostat sensor, or ambient cab temperature sensor, may
cause short cycling of the compressor.
6. Eagle climate controllers are designed to use normally closed heat solenoid valves.
7. Disconnect the vehicle battery leads, if a machine is to be inactive, or put into storage, for a period of a
week or more. The current drain from the controller’s memory may result in a dead vehicle battery. An
optional ignition relay may be installed to disable the controller’s memory function, when the key switch is
turned off.
20-704
0
30 DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY
30-I
0
PPC VALVE
Removal ............................... 30-165
Installation .............................. 30-166
Disassembly ............................ 30-167
Assembly .............................. 30-I 68
BUCKET CYLINDER
Removal ............................... 30-I 69
Installation .............................. 30-I 70
BOOM CYLINDER
Removal ............................... 30-I 71
Installation .............................. 30-I 72
HYDRAULIC CYLINDER
Disassembly ............................ 30-I 73
Assembly .............................. 30-I 76
WORK EQUIPMENT
Removal ............................... 30-I 79
Installation .............................. 30-182
COUNTERWEIGHT)
Removal and Installation ................... 30-I 84
CAB
Removal ............................... 30-I 85
Installation .............................. 30-I 87
MAIN MONITOR
Removal ............................... 30-190
Installation .............................. 30-I 91
MAINTENANCE MONITOR
Removal and Installation ................... 30-192
30-2
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY METHOD OF USING MANUAL
(1) When removing or installing a unit assembly, the order of work and techniques used are given
for the removal operation; the order of work for the installation operation is not given.
(2) Any special techniques applying only to the installation procedure are marked m, and the
same mark is placed after the relevant step in the removal procedure to indicate which step in
the installation procedure it applies to.
(Example)
REMOVAL OF 0 0 0 ASSEMBLY ...... ..... . Title of operation
A ................................................................. Precautions related to safety when carrying out
the operation
1. XXXX (1) ............................... .... .......... Step in operation
* . ......................... ................................ Technique or important point to remember when
removing XXXX (I).
2. AAA (2): .............................................. m Indicates that a’ technique is listed for use
during installation
3. 0 p 0 •Jassembly (3)
.(. ....... ............... ... ........................... See Lubricant and Coolant Table
INSTALLATION OF 0 0 0 ASSEMBLY .... Title of operation
l Carry out installation in the reverse
order to removal.
p ..... ...... ................... .................. Technique used during installation
........... ........... .. ... ..................... Technique or important point to remember when
installing AAA (21.
l Adding water, oil ... ... ................. ... ... Step in operation
* . ................................ ............... Point to remember when adding water or oil
2. General precautions when carrying out installation or removal (disassembly or assembly) of units
are given together as PRECAUTION WHEN CARRYING OUT OPERATION, so be sure to follow
these precautions when carrying out the operation.
(1) For details of the description, part number, and quantity of any tools (Al, etc.) that appear in
the operation procedure, see the SPECIAL TOOLS LIST given in this manual.
30-3
0
PRECAUTIONS WHEN CARRYING OUT OPERATION
[When carrying out removal or installation (disassembly or assembly) of units, be sure to follow the
general precautions given below when carrying out the operation.1
3) If the part is not under hydraulic pressure, the following corks can be used.
Dimensions
~~~~e~’ Part number
OldjL
06 1 0704S-W608 1 6 1 5- 1 8 A
A
08 1 0704960811 1 8 1 6.5 1 11
Taper l/8
n -0
a a
16 1 0704961620 1 16 1 134 20 1
1
18 1 0704961822 1 18 1 15 1 22
L
DEWW401
30-4
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY PRECAUTION WHEN CARRYING OUT OPERATION
0 Tighten all bolts and nuts (sleeve nuts) to the specified (KES) torque.
0 Install the hoses without twisting or interference.
l Replace all gaskets, O-rings, cotter pins, and lock plates with new parts.
0 Bend the cotter pin or lock plate securely.
0 When coating with adhesive, clean the part and remove all oil and grease, then coat the threaded
portion with 2 - 3 drops of adhesive.
a When coating with gasket sealant, clean the surface and remove all oil and grease, check that there
is no dirt or damage, then coat uniformly with gasket sealant.
0 Clean all parts, and correct any damage, dents, burrs, or rust.
0 Coat rotating parts and sliding parts with engine oil.
l When press fitting parts, coat the surface with antifriction compound (LM-PI.
0 After fitting snap rings, check that the snap ring is fitted securely ,in the ring groove.
0 When connecting wiring connectors, clean the connector to remove all oil, dirt, or water, then
connect securely.
0 When using eyebolts, check that there is no deformation or deterioration, screw them fully, and
align the direction of the hook.
0 When tightening split flanges, tighten uniformly in turn to prevent excessive tightening on one
side.
* When operating the hydraulic cylinders for the first time after reassembling cylinders, pumps and
other hvdraulic eauioment removed for repair, always bleed the air as follows:
1) Start the engine-and run at low idling.-
2) Operate the work equipment control lever to operate the hydraulic cylinder 4 - 5 times,
8 stopping 100 mm from the end of its stroke.
0)
z 3) Next, operate the steering, bucket, and boom cylinders 3 ,- 4 times to the end of their strokes,
3 then stop the engine and loosen air bleed plug (1) to bleed the air from the hydraulic tank.
After bleeding the air, tighten plug (1).
4) Following this, raise the engine speed, repeat the procedure in Step 3)
to bleed the air. Repeat this operation until no more air comes out from
the plug hole.
m Plug : 11.3 f 1.5 Nm (1.15 f 0.15 kgm)
5) After doing this, run the engine at normal speed.
* When using the machine for the first time after repair or
long storage, follow the same procedure.
0 If the coolant has been drained, tighten the drain valve, and add water to the specified level. Run
the engine to circulate the water through the system. Then check the water level again.
0 If the hydraulic equipment has been removed and installed again, add engine oil to the specified
level.
Run the engine to circulate the oil through the system. Then check the oil level again.
l If the piping or hydraulic equipment, such as hydraulic cylinders, pumps, or motors, have been
removed for repair, always bleed the air from the system after reassembling the parts.
* For details, see TESTlNG AND ADJUSTING, Bleeding air.
0 Add the specified amount. of grease (molybdenum disulphide grease) to the work equipment
related parts.
30-5
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY SPECIAL TOOL LIST
Nature of work
T
Iiymbol Part No. Part Name
- -
-
1 m-ao-noo 1Stand Ill I
-
2 mwo-1370 1Guide pin 151 I
Removal, installation
3 793-310-1330 Plate 1 of
- end plate
Disassembly, assembly of 4 01541-61260 Nut 2
transmission clutch pack 9 -
assembly
-
5 793-310-1360 1Bar I4 I
6 793-415-I 160 Seal holder 1 F-R
- Jig for
7 7g3415-I170 Seal holder I lst, 3rd settling
piston seal
s 793-415-1130 Seal hoder 1 2nd, 4th
- -
1
-
Disassembly, assembly of C
differential assembly
3
-
799-101-5002 Hydraulic tester kit
a
-
5
- 790-101-1102 I Pump assembly III I
1 Puller assembly:
790-101-3100
2
Removal of axle shaft
3 bearing
-
793-520-2301 I Seai support assembiy I I I I
Disassembly, assembly of
axle housing assembly
D 793-520-2310 I l Support Ill I
4 793-520-2380 l support I
Note I : Items listed as 79OT-ooo-oooO are tools prohibited for supply (locally manufactured).
Note 2 : Items marked 0 in the Sketch Column are special tools with sketches introduced in this
Shop Manual.
30-6
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY SPECIAL TOOL LIST
790-502-1003
or Cvlinder repair stand 1
F 790-502-2000 - .
790-101-l 102 PUrnD 1
SteerinalRemoval, iwt$lation
.G C indeT of rcund.hea
H
$$i+iyr.._-..___
11,iiiiiS%in
C tinder of n on nut
Press ftiinn of coil
bushing - .’
Kit Part No.: 790-201-1702
8 I
m
=;
3
Disassembly, assembly of
hydraulic cylinder
-
1 Installation of piston ring
1
-
Bucket,
Boom
cylinder
2
796-720-1740 Ring 1 Steering
07281-00809 Clamp cylinder
1
-
790-101-5021 Grip 1 Insertion of dust seal
Kit Part No.: 790-201-1506
0101050816 Bolt 1
K
790-201-1640 Plate 1
790-201-1550 Plate 1
790-210-1630 Plate 1
30-7
a
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY SKETCHES OF SPECIAL TOOLS
05. holder
30-8
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TORQUE CONVERTER CHARGING PUMP
REMOVAL OF TORQUE
CONVERTER CHARGING PUMP
ASSEMBLY
Astop the machine on level ground and install
the safety bar on the frame. Lower the bucket
to the ground ,and stop the engine. Then apply
the parking brake and put blocks under the
wheels to prevent the machine from moving.
1. Covers
Remove cover (I) at bottom of cab, transmis-
sion inspection cover (21, and hood cover (3).
2. Hydraulic piping
Disconnect the following hydraulic piping. m
l Disconnect hose tube (4) between filter and
pump from pump.
* Remove the heater hose clamp from the
hood.
l Disconnect hose tube (5) between transmis-
sion and pump from pump.
. Disconnect tube (6) between transmission
strainer and pump from pump.
* Remove the wiring clamp mounting
E
bolts. I
G
2 3. Torque converter charging pump
Remove mounting bolts, then remove charging
pump (71. m
* Fit lifting equipment to prevent the pump
from falling.
INSTALLATION OF TORQUE
CONVERTER CHARGING PUMP
ASSEMBLY
l Carry out installation in the reverse order to
removal.
m
* Check that there is an O-ring installed.
m Tube hose mounting bolt :
30.9 f 3.4 Nm (3.15 f 0.35 kgm)
w Tube mounting bolt :
110 f 12.3 Nm (11.25 f 1.25 kgm)
0
* Check that there is an O-ring fitted to the
mating surface with the housing.
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TORQUE CONVERTER
DISASSEMBLY OF TORQUE
CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
1. Turbine case assembly
1) Remove stator shaft and pump assembly (2)
from turbine and case assembly (3).
I CBWJOlY
30-10
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TORQUE CONVERTER
2. Stator
I) Remove snap ring (9).
3. Stator shaft
Using forcing screws 0, push from stator shaft
(11) end, and disconnect from pump assembly
(12).
,I2
LB&OX61
4. Gear
Remove gear (13) from pump (14).
5. Bearing
Remove bearing (15) from gear (13).
30-11
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TORQUE CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY OF TORQUE
CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
1. Bearing
Install bearing (15) to gear (13).
2. Gear
Install gear (13) to pump.
QECI Mounting bolt :
66.2 + 7.4 Nm (6.75 + 0.75 kgm1
DBWCG164
I
3. Stator shaft
1) Install seal ring (16) to stator shaft (II).
& Seal ring : Grease (G2-LII
t Make the extension of the seal ring uni-
form.
2) Push inner race end of bearing, and install
pump assembly (12) to stator shaft (I I).
4. Stator
I) Install ring 117).
30-12
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TORQUE CONVERTER
30-13
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
DISASSEMBLY OF
TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
. Remove the left and right mount brackets from
the transmission assembly first.
1. Oil filler, rear coupling
Remove oil filler (I) and rear coupling (2).
* Lower the transmission assembly and install
it to the assembly stand.
2. Hydraulic piping
1) Remove tube hose (3) between strainer and
charging pump.
2) Remove tube hose (4) between torque con-
verter filter and transmission valve from
transmission valve.
* Remove the tube clamps.
4. Charging pump
II Remove hoses and flanges (8) and (9) from
charging pump (IO) and housing.
2) Remove charging pump (IO).
30-14
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
5. Hydraulic piping
1) Remove PT6 lubrication tube (II).
* Be careful not to crush the tube during
the operation.
* After removing the tube, fit a cover to
protect the thread.
2) Remove clamp of hose (9).
6. Oil filter
1) Remove mounting bracket of oil filter (12L
then remove together with bracket, filter, and
hose.
7. Rear housing
1) Remove torque converter pilot cap (13).
2) Install tool Al to rear housing (141 and sling.
* Install tool Al securely so that it does
not come off.
Al
15
II+ kg Rear housing, torque converter
assembly : 166 kg
DIMJO
30-I 5
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
8. Torque converter
Lift off torque converter (16) from rear housing
(14).
* Before removing, use a felt pen to make
match marks on the mating surface of the
housing and torque converter.
18
8
17
3) Insert screwdriver between rear housing (14)
20
and shaft (221, then lever shaft and push
down to remove.
9
-laz
30-16
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
23
24 -185
25
DSWOXSS
27 \\\
32 DB\ivoo169
13. Bearing
I) Remove FORWARD, REVERSE outer bearing
(281, 1st. 3rd outer bearing (291, and 2nd, 4th
outer bearing (30) from housing.
30-18
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
bolts.
Jr Bolt length of tool A4: 64 mm
47 46 47 48
52 D6WOO198
30-20
0
TRANSMISSION
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY
DLWOOMl
5756 DBWOMOZ
62
30-21
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
30-22
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
DLWWZll
19. Covers
1) Remove covers (70) and (71).
* Remove both the O-rings.
71
7 DBWUOZ12
30-23
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
ASSEMBLY OF
TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY
1. Covers
Assemble O-rings and assemble covers (70) and
(71) to front housing.
* Be careful not to the O-rings fall out.
Sr Install O-ring (72) to the mating surface of
the parking brake housing.
& Outside circumference of O-ring :
Grease (G2-LI)
67
DLLWJ213
30-24
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
I DLwx214
30-25
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
30-26
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
30-27
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
43-
3,
7) Install manual cancel bolt (39) to parking
brake housing (431, and set piston to FREE
position.
30-28
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
12) Press fit oil seal (42) and dust seal (41) to
cover (40).
Press-fitting dimension a : 28.5 F 1 mm
Press-fitting dimension b : 17.5 + 1 mm
& Lip of oil seal : Grease (GZ-LII Coat lip of
oil seal with G2-Ll
30-29
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
b a 34 35
6. Idler gear
1) Press fit bearings (33) to idler gear (32). 32
2) Press fit idler gear (32) to shaft, and install
/
snap ring (31).
f If the shaft has been removed, cool the
shaft to -7O”C, then press fit it to dimen-
sion g.
Ir Shaft dimension g : 46.5 f 0.5 mm
32 9
I 33 DBW00191
7. Bearing
1) Assemble FORWARD, REVERSE outer bear-
ing (281, Ist, 3rd outer bearing (291, and 2nd,
4th outer bearing (30) to housing.
30-30
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
24 lxWuo185
23
mwcmi
1
22 mmmz
30-32
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
/r- \t
careful of the meshing with the pump acces- 14
sory gear, and install. (I
Sr Blow in air to check if the oil holes are cor-
rectly aligned.
m Mounting bolt :
112.8 f9.8 Nm (11.5 f 1.0 kgml
30-33
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
tBWOO178
Al
IA
30-34
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
e85
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
30-36
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION
r;
20. Adjusting speedometer sensor
11 Screw in sensor (75) until it contacts outer- I Transmission case
30-37
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
DISASSEMBLY OF
TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
ASSEMBLY
the top.
1. Bearing
Using puller and remove bearing (1).
II 8 6 5 3
DBW0024.3
3. End plate I I B3 85
I) Install tools B3 and 85, then tighten tool B4,
’ and remove ring (9). /
* After removing the ring, remove tool B3.
DBbWl245
30-38
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
4. Clutch plate
Remove plate (ll), disc (121, and spring (13)
from housing.
5. Piston
Blow air in FORWARD oil hole of shaft and re-
move piston (14).
* If the piston is at an angle and cannot be
removed, push the piston in and try to re-
move it again.
-k Do not use force to remove it. The inside
circumference of the cylinder will be dam-
aged.
6. Snap ring
* Set on tool 61 with the REVERSE clutch side
at the top.
Remove snap ring (15).
8. Shaft, cylinder
1) Remove snap ring (26) from shaft and hous- 27 28 26
ing (251, then remove housing (27).
2) Remove snap ring (281, then remove hous-
ing (27).
30-39
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
2. 1st gear
1) Remove snap ring (331, then remove thrust
washer (34).
2) Remove 1st gear (351, and needle bearings
(36) and (37).
35
9
0
34
L%Ww252
3. End plate
1) Install tool B3 and 85, then tighten tool B4,
B5 84
and remove ring (38).
* After removing the ring, remove tool B3.
83
38
30-40
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
4. Clutch plate
42
I) Remove plate (40), disc (41), and spring (42)
from housing.
2) Remove thrust washer.(43).
5. Piston
Blow air in REVERSE oil hole of shaft, and re-
move piston (44).
* If the piston is at an angle and cannot be
removed, push the piston in and try to re-
move it again.
* Do not use force to remove it. The inside
circumference of the cylinder will be dam-
aged.
I DBww257
6. Bearing
Set on tool Bl with the 3rd clutch side at the
top.
Using puller, remove bearing (45).
7. 3rd gear
Remove spacer (46), thrust washer (47), needle
bearing (48), and 3rd gear (49).
* Use the same procedure as in Steps 3 - 5
for the 1st gear to continue disassembly.
30-41
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
2. 4th gear
1) Remove thrust washer (521, 4th gear (53),
needle bearing (54), and thrust washer (55).
2) Remove snap ring (561, spacer (571, and nee-
dle bearing (58) from 4th gear (53).
54 52
3. End plate
1) Install tools B3 and B5, then tighten tool B4,
56 57 58 53
and remove ring (59).
* After removing the ring, remove tool B3.
30-42
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
4. Clutch plate
Remove plate (611, disc (62), and spring (63)
from housing.
5. Piston
Blow air in 4th oil hole of shaft, and remove
piston (64).
If the piston is at an angle and cannot be
removed, push the piston in and try to re-
move it again.
Do not use force to remove it. The inside
circumference of the cylinder will be dam-
aged.
6. Idler gear
* Set on tool Bl with the 2nd clutch side at
/ 65
the top.
1) Remove snap ring (65).
2) Using puller, remove spacer (661, inner bear-
ing (671, and idler gear (68).
* When fitting the puller, put the plate in con-
tact with the center first.
7. 2nd gear
Remove thrust washer (691, needle bearing (701,
2nd gear (711, and thrust washer (72).
* Use the same procedure as in Steps 3 - 5
for the 2nd gear to continue disassembly.
72 71 70 69
30-43
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
ASSEMBLY OF
TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
ASSEMBLY
Transmission oil
4. REVERSE piston
Install REVERSE piston (73).
* Be careful not to damage the piston seal.
f Check that the spring pin does not extend
from the circumference of the shaft.
& Sliding surface of piston seal :
Transmission oil
5. Clutch plate
Insert tool B2 into housing, then assemble plate
(741, disc (751, and spring (76) in turn.
* Soak disc (75) in clean transmission oil for
at least 2 minutes before assembling.
* Be careful to assemble so that disc (75) and
spring (76) are not resting on each other.
* Be careful that the plate or spring are not
caught in the clutch housing ring groove
when assembling.
30-44
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
6. End plate
83
1) Install tools B3 and 85, then tighten tool B4
to push in end plate (77). 85
OBWW271
7. Thrust washer
Assemble washer (241, thrust bearing (231, and
thrust washer (22).
8. REVERSE gear
Align spline groove on inside of plate with a
screwdriver to assemble gear (17).
* If the gear spline does not match, turn lightly 22
when assembling. Never use force to push
23
it in.
z! 24
2 9. Needle bearing oLwo2.26a
2 Assemble needle bearing (21) and thrust washer
(20).
* Check that the end face of the thrust washer
is below the surface of the stepped portion
of the shaft.
10. Bearing
1) Assemble spacer (191, then press fit inner
bearing (18) and spacer (16).
* Press fit completely so that there is no
clearance.
a Thrust washer : Transmission oil
2) Assemble snap ring (15).
I
3) After press fitting bearing, check that clear-
ance “a” between thrust washer and spacer
is within standard value.
* a = 0.106 - 0.991 mm
30-45
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
OBVvtX,274
30-46
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
17. Spacer
Assemble thrust washer (31, then assemble
spacer (2).
Sr Check that the end face of the thrust race of
the thrust washer is below the surface of the
stepped portion of the shaft.
& Thrust washer : Transmission oil
18. Bearing
Press fit bearing (I).
* Press fit completely so that the spacer is in
tight contact with bearing (1) at the stepped
portion of the shaft.
c%nQoz79
30-47
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
1. Piston seal
Assemble piston seal (79-I) to piston (79).
Ir When assembling a new piston seal, use
‘tool B7 to make the seal fit well (time: approx. Piston seal before
using tool B7
2 - 3 minutes), then assemble the seal.
* If the seal is assembled to the cylinder with-
out making it fit first, the seal will be dam-
aged.
6 Inside surface of tool B7 :
Transmission oil
87
2. 3rd piston
Install 3rd piston (79).
* Be careful not to damage the piston seal.
It Check that the spring pin does not extend
from the circumference of the shaft.
a Sliding surface of piston seal :
Transmission oil
3. Clutch plate
82 81 80
Assemble plate (801, disc (811, and spring (82) in
turn to housing.
* Soak disc (81) in clean transmission oil for
at least 2 minutes before assembling.
* Be careful to assemble so that disc (81) and
spring (82) are not resting on each other.
* Be careful that plate (80) or spring (82) are
not caught in the clutch housing ring groove
when assembling.
30-48
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
4. End plate
1) Install tools B3 and B5, then tighten tool B4
to push in end plate (83).
2) Assemble ring (841, and remove tool 83.
* Check that ring (84) is fitted securely in
the groove.
* Check that the disc rotates smoothly by
hand.
5. 3rd gear 85
48
Assemble 3rd gear (491, then assemble needle
bearing (48).
Ir If the gear spline does not match, turn lightly
when assembling. Never use force to push
it in.
* Assemble the needle bearing at the bottom
first.
6. Bearing
Assemble thrust washer (47) and spacer (46L 45
then press fit bearing (45).
Ir Check that the end face of the thrust washer 46
is below the surface of the stepped portion
of the shaft.
47
* Press fit completely so that the spacer is in
tight contact with bearing (45) at the stepped
portion of the shaft.
30-49
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
7. 1st piston
1) Turn over clutch pack.
A When turning over the clutch pack, be
careful not to get your fingers caught
between the stand and clutch pack.
2) In the same way .as with 3rd piston, make
sure that piston seal fits well before assem-
bling it to piston (441.
3) Assemble piston (44) in the same way as
3rd piston.
& Sliding surface of piston seal :
Transmission oil
8. Clutch plate
42 41
Assemble plate (401, disc (411, and spring (42) in
turn to housing.
-Lr Assemble in the same way as for the 3rd
clutch plate.
9. End tAate
1) Install tools B3 and B5, then tighten tool 64
to push in end plate (39).
B5
2) Assemble ring (381, and remove tools B3
and 84.
* Assemble in the same way as for the
3rd end plate.
30-50
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
12. Bearing
I) Press fit inner bearing (31) and spacer (30).
2) Assemble snap ring (29).
* Fit the snap ring securely in the shaft
groove.
30-51
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
1. Piston seal
86
Assemble piston seal (86-l) to piston (86).
* When assembling a new piston seal, use
tool B8 to make the seal fit well (time: approx.
2 - 3 minutes), then assemble the seal.
* If the seal is assembled to the cylinder with-
out making it fit first, the seal will be dam-
47-
86-l
Piston seal before
using toll 88
aged.
& Inside surface of tool B8 :
Transmission oil 86-l
2. 2nd piston
Install 2nd piston (86).
* Be careful not to damage the piston seal.
* Check that the spring pin does not extend
from the circumference of the shaft.
3. Clutch plate
Assemble plate (871, disc (881, and spring (89) in
turn to housing.
-k Soak disc (88) in clean transmission oil for
at least 2 minutes before assembling.
J, Be careful to assemble so that disc (88) and
spring (89) are not resting on each other.
* Be careful that the plate or spring are not
caught in the clutch housing ring groove
when assembling.
30-52
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
4. End plate
I 83 84
1) Install tools B3 and B5, then tighten tool B4
to push in end plate (90).
2) Assemble ring (911, and remove tool B3.
* Check that the disc rotates smoothly by
hand.
5. Thrust washer
Assemble thrust washer (72).
6. 2nd gear ! I
Assemble 2nd gear (711, then assemble needle c
bearing (70).
* If the gear spline’does not match, turn lightly
when assembling. Never use force to push
it in.
7. Idler gear
Assemble thrust washer (69) and idler gear (68).
* Check that the end face of the thrust washer
is below the surface of the stepped portion
of the shaft.
6 Thrust washer : Transmission oil
8. Bearing
1) Press fit inner bearing (67) and spacer (66).
2) Assemble snap ring (65).
Ir Fit the snap ring securely in the shaft
groove.
* After press fitting the bearing, check that
clearance “en between the thrust washer 69
and the idler gear is within the standard
value.
* e = 0.34 - 1.66 mm
65
\
67
68
DBWW301
DLVvQ2273
30-53
al
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
9. 4th piston
I) Turn over clutch pack.
a When turning over the clutch pack, be
careful not to get your fingers caught
between the stand and clutch pack.
2) In the same way, as with 1st piston, make
sure that piston seal fits well before assem-
bling it to piston (64).
3) Assemble piston (64) in the same way as
2nd piston.
,=!j& Sliding surface of piston seal :
Transmission oil
30-54
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CLUTCH PACK
13. Bearing
Assemble idler gear (501, then press fit bearing 52
(51). .54
* Press fit completely so that the idler gear is
in tight contact with bearing (51) at the
stepped portion of the shaft.
* After press fitting the bearing, check that
clearance “f” between the thrust washer and
the idler gear is within the standard value.
* f = 0.17 - 1.43 mm
REMOVAL OF TRANSMISSION
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
I I
I \ DEVK0312
30-56
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
5. Electric wiring
1) Disconnect clamp of transmission wiring (10)
from transmission valve.
2) Disconnect transmission wiring (II), (121,
(131, (141, and (15) from transmission valve.
m
* Fit tags to distinguish the wiring.
30-57
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
INSTALLATION OF
TRANSMISSION CONTROL
VALVE ASSEMBLY
e80 e90
. Carry out installation in the reverse order to
removal.
m
* Use a new part for the gasket.
* Wash and remove all oil and grease from
the mounting bolts and bolt holes.
6 Mounting bolt: Thread tightener (LT-2)
w Mounting bolt :
34.3 f 4.9 Nm (3.5 + 0.5 kgml El15 DBWW317
30-58
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
DISASSEMBLY OF
TRANSMISSION CONTROL
VALVE ASSEMBLY
?+A
:J---34
I 37 .a
UJ -/
@ \ 24
23 oBwoo318
30-60
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
1. Disconnection
Remove mounting bolts, and disconnect upper
valve (2) from lower valve (I), then remove gas-
ket (3).
30-61
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY OF
TRANSMISSION CONTROL
VALVE ASSEMBLY
10
20 11 '
d 13 \
21
\ I
x-m
23
30-62
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
-4a
Mounting bolt :
30.9 f 3.4 Nm (3.15 f 0.35 kgm)
* Install guide bolts.
* Replace the gasket with a new part.
6) Install return spring (47) (L=46) and brake
valve (46).
7) Install priority valve (45).
8) Install sleeve (44) and F return spring
(43) (L=42), and set gasket (42) in posi-
tion, then install cover (41).
m Mounting bolt :
30.9 f 3.4 Nm (3.15 + 0.35 kgm)
* Install guide bolts.
* Replace the gasket with a new part.
30-63
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
&7mm
23mm
Mwoe319
30-64
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION ACCUMULATOR VALVE
DISASSEMBLY OF
TRANSMISSION
ACCUMULATOR VALVE
ASSEMBLY
i” \
* Reference
16” 1ST
30-65
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION ACCUMULATOR VALVE
6-hnm 2-3mm
DAW00327
ASSEMBLY OF
TRANSMISSION
ACCUMULATOR VALVE
ASSEMBLY
1. Using pads, set accumulator valve cover (IO) in
vice.
* Be careful not to tighten the vice on the
cover with excessive force.
2. Assemble spacers (18), and (161, stoppers (131,
(151, and (131, and springs (121, (141, and (12) to
accumulator valve cover (IO), then insert valve
(11) from top of each spring.
3. Fit O-rings (20) and (21) in each groove of accu-
mulator valve body (9).
* Assemble the O-ring securely in the body
groove. *
4. Assemble accumulator valve body (9) perpen-
dicularly from above cover (IO), then temporar-
ily install with guide bolts.
* Assemble the body carefully and be sure
that the O-ring does not fall out.
5. Push in accumulator valve body (9), and remove
guide bolts, then secure with standard bolt.
w Mounting bolt :
54 f 19.6 Nm (5.5 + 2.0 kgm)
. Mounting bolt : 8 mm (width across flats)
30-66
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION MODULATING VALVE
DISASSEMBLY OF
TRANSMISSION MODULATING
VALVE ASSEMBLY
\16
30-67
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY TRANSMISSION MODULATING VALVE
ASSEMBLY OF
TRANSMISSION MODULATING
VALVE ASSEMBLY
6
30-68
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DRIVE SHAFT
DISASSEMBLY OF DRIVE
SHAFT ASSEMBLY
mm5
I
I
2. Center drive shaft, rear drive shaft
I) Carry out the same operation as in Step I)
for the front drive shaft.
30-69
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DRIVE SHAFT
3. Spider, bearing
1) Remove bearing caps (5) and seal.
30-70
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DRIVE SHAFT
I
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DRIVE SHAFT
DEWWS19
30-72
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY FRONT AXLE
el ko
Front drive shaft: 15 kg
3. Brake tube
Disconnect brake tube (2).
4. Tire, wheel
Put sling around tire (31, then remove mounting
bolts and lift off. a
5. Axle
1) Using jack and hoist, sling axle (41, and re-
move mounting bolts. m
* Adjust the height of the jack, then re-
move the mounting bolts.
eel
kfi Axle : 724’ kg
30-74
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY FRONT AXLE
INSTALLATION OF FRONT
AXLE ASSEMBLY
l Carry out installation in the reverse order to
removal.
m
m Mounting bolt :
68.6 k 4.9 Nm (7.0 + 0.5 kgm)
B
w Tube nut :
80.9 f 12.3 Nm (8.25 f 1.25 kgm1
m
w Mounting bolt :
927 f 103 Nm (94.5 + 10.5 kgm)
a
Jc Use the bolt as a guide to align the mount-
ing position.
w Mounting bolt :
927 f 98 Nm (94.5 + 10.0 kgm)
(width across flats : 36 mm)
30-75
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY REAR AXLE
:
u Engine oil : 31 e
2. Fuel tank
Remove fuel tank.
For details, see REMOVAL OF FUEL TANK AS-
SEMBLY.
3. Jacking up chassis
1) Set block @ between left and right rear axles
and rear frame.
4. Tire, wheel
Put sling around tire (31, then remove mounting
bolts and lift off. m
30-76
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY REAR AXLE
7. Axle
I) Secure pivot to axle with wire.
* Fix the pivot securely so that it does not
move.
2) Remove engine drain hose and tube (12)
from engine oil pan.
30-77
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY REAR AXLE
8. Rear pivot
1) Remove trunnion cap (15). m
21 Remove mounting bolts, them remove plate
(16) and thrust washer (17). El
30-78
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY REAR AXLE
9. Front pivot
I) Remove packing (25) from front pivot (24).
la
2) Remove bushing (26) from front piv0t.m
24
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY REAR AXLE
a
* Use the bolt as a guide to set to the mount-
ing position.
* When tightening the mounting bolts, do not
tighten in one step. Divide the torque and
tighten in three steps.
* After installing the axle assembly, remove
the wire.
m Mounting bolt :
927 k 98 Nm (94.5 f 10.0 kgm)
Packing
(Width across fiats : 36 mm)
pCJ
* Remove all oil and grease from the mount-
ing bolts and bolt holes.
w Mounting bolt: DLwoo3Q
u : Engine oil : 31 e
30-80
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL
DISASSEMBLY OF
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
1. Draining oil
Remove drain plug (I), and drain oil.
Q Axle oil : 32 e
2. Axle assembly
1) Set axle assembly (2) on pallet.
kn
IE?I Axle assembly : 724 kg (front)
3. Differential cover
Remove bleeder screws (41, then remove differ-
ential cover (5).
4. Axle housing
1) Sling axle housing assembly (6), and remove
housing mounting bolts.
* Make match marks on the housings to
prevent mistakes between the left and
right axle housings.
* Set blocks to prevent the assembly from
tilting when the housing assembly on
one side is removed.
kn
rE?l Axle housing assembly : 250 kg (front)
30-8 1
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL
5. Cage
I) Screw in forcing screws (I 4 mm, P=2, 8
L=SOmm), and using guide bolts (71, remove
cage assembly (8).
* Check the number of shims and use as
reference when assembling.
* Loosen the mounting bolts of the cou-
pling, and fit temporarily.
6. Brake piston
Install bleeder screw, blow in compressed air
from portion a, raise housing and piston (101,
and remove.
* If the D-ring is damaged, blow in air sud-
denly to make a gap between the housing
and piston, then use a screwdriver to lever it
out and remove it.
* When removing the piston, be careful not to
damage the housing and piston surface.
30-82
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL
a- ‘f,
30-83
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL
23
Bevel gear : 16 kg
Flange half : 21 kg
(25).
9. Coupling
1) Remove mounting bolt (281, then remove 26
holder (291, coupling (301, and O-ring (31).
* Do not remove the protector press fitted
to the coupling unless necessary.
2) Remove oil seal (32).
I 25 27 14
DLWla3n
31 28 29 -30
28
30-84
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL
Press
stand 36 33
DLwcQ3a3
35
oLbmm1
11. Cage
Remove bearing cups (38) and (39) from cage
(37). 0 0
0 O 0
0
37 $9
=O,_/OOdY3g0 0
30-85
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL
ASSEMBLY OF DIFFERENTIAL
ASSEMBLY
1. Cage
Press fit bearing cups (39) and (38) to cage (37).
* After press fitting the cup, check that there
is no clearance at portion a.
* Coat the cup press-fitting portion with oil.
& Cup press-fitting portion : Oil (axle oil)
2. Pinion gear
1) Press fit bearing cone (36) to pinion gear
(331, and assemble spacer (35).
* Check that there is no clearance at the
mating surface of each part.
2) Assemble pinion gear (33) to cage (37), and
press fit bearing cone (34).
* Use a press to apply pressure at the
specified load to the bearing, and rotate
the case to settle the bearing.
* Press load : 102 KN (10.4 ton)
& Bearing : Oil (axle oil)
* Reference
l Starting turning force @: Max. 59.5N
(6.07 kg)
. End play : 0 - 0.15 mm
* When the case has been rotated at the
specified load, check that it can be ro-
tated smoothly by hand.
* If the rotation is heavy, replace the bear-
ing and spacer, then check again.
3) Coat seal press-fitting portion of cage (37)
with gasket sealant, then press fit oil seal
(32).
* Press fit so that the oil seal is level with
the surface of portion b.
Aj& Oil press-fitting portion :
Gasket sealant (Seal end 242)
& Lip of oil seal : Grease (G2-LII
32
\ b
30-86
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL
3. Coupling
Install coupling (30), O-ring (311, and holder (29)
to pinion gear (331, and tighten mounting bolts.
* Tighten the mounting bolts temporarily, and
tighten fully after assembling.
* When inserting the coupling, be extremely
careful not to damage the seal.
Aj& Mounting bolt : Thread tightener (LT-2)
(When tightening fully)
B Mounting bolt :
279 C 29 Nm (28.5 + 3.0 kgm)
14 27
25
d mm
30-87
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL
18
30-88
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL
31 Selection of shims
t = C - (L + D/2)
t : Shim thickness
C: (A + a) - (B + b)
L : Actual measured value
D: Diameter of tool Cl
A: 189 + 0.3
B: 59 * 0.3
a: Deviation from dimension A
b: Deviation from dimension B
* Use the actual measured value for di-
mension D.
* Adjust so that shim thickness “t” is within
a range of 0.73 - 1.41 mm.
* Mark the end face of the pinion gear
with an electric pen as follows.
MD + 0.10 (- 0.01)
L Dimension b
(unit: mm)
1 Dimension a Cl
(unit: mm)
30-89
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL
6. Bearing carrier
Press fit bearing cones (42) and (43) to bearing
carrier assemblies (12) and (12-I).
& Bearing cup press-fitting portion :
_ Oil (axle oil)
* After press fitting the bear-
ing, check that there is no 4243
clearance at portion f. f
&
0.95 mm
* Assemble the differential carrier assem-
bly so that the bevel gear is on the right
side as seen from the cage mount end.
* Assemble the bearing carrier assembly
without the square ring and D-ring, and
adjust.
* Rotate the bevel gear and coat the bear-
ing with oil.
6 Bearing oil : Oil (axle oil)
* To settle all the parts, rotate the bevel
gear when tightening.
0.55 - 0.95 mm
30-90
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL
8. Cage
1) Fit O-ring (9) in groove of cage assembly (8).
& O-ring : Oil (axle oil)
* Coat thinly with oil.
DBwJ1574
9. Adjusting backlash
1) Measure backlash of bevel gear with dial
gauge.
* Backlash standard value: 0.25 - 0.38 mm
* Measure the backlash at three places
around the circumference of the bevel
gear, and check that the variation be-
tween each measurement is less than
0.1 mm.
30-9 1
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL
* When adjusting the bevel gear, do not change the preload of the bearing. Adjust by moving shims between
the left and right. Always keep the same total thickness of shims.
30-92
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL
Diierential housing
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL
14. Coupling
Tighten mounting bolts of coupling (30) fully.
& Mounting bolt : Thread tightener (LT-2)
QEI Mounting bolt :
279 f 29.4 Nm (28.5 f 3.0 kgm)
30-94
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY DIFFERENTIAL
30-95
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY AXLE HOUSING
DISASSEMBLY OF AXLE
HOUSING ASSEMBLY
1. Draining oil
Remove drain plug (1) and drain oil.
Q Axle oil : 32 e
2. Differential cover
Using forcing screws, remove differential cover
(3).
* Do not remove the differential cover unless
necessary.
* When removing the differential cover, be
careful not to damage the bleeder screw.
* When moving the differential assembly, re-
move the 4 cover mounting bolts, and use
eyebolts (M=12, P=1.75) to lift at 4 points
and move.
3. Axle housing
1) Sling axle housing assembly (4), and remove
housing mounting bolts.
* Make match marks on the housings to
prevent mistakes between the left and
right axle housings.
* Set blocks to prevent the assembly from
tilting when the housing assembly on
one side is removed.
30-96
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY AXLE HOUSING
IX401598
Detail P
8. Ring gear
Use puller @ and pull up uniformly to remove
ring gear (15) from axle housing (16).
f Assemble spacer @ to the end face of the
puller bolt to adjust the height.
* When pulling up with the puller, be ex-
tremely careful that the teeth of the puller
do not come off the ring gear.
15
30-98
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY AXLE HOUSING
9. Axle shaft
1) Stand housing and shaft assembly, then raise
housing (16).
2) Put a copper hammer in contact with end
face of axle shaft (171, then knock in shaft
and rotate.housing (16) to remove shaft.
Copper hammer
16
16
MwO1603
30-99
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY AXLE HOUSING
MWJ1610
DLwO1611
30-100
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY AXLE HOUSING
MW1614
NW01615
28,
\ 29
DLbW1619
30-101
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY AXLE HOUSING
2. Axle shaft
11 Assemble outer oil seal (22) to inner oil seal
(19).
,=!J& Lip of outer oil seal : Grease (G2-LI)
2) Press fit oil seal to axle shaft (17) with a
press.
* Be careful not to deform the parts when
hitting with a hammer.
* Coat the sleeve contact surface portion
b of the ‘oil seal thinly with axle oil.
& Sleeve contact surface of shaft :
Axle oil
18
3. Housing
I) Stand shaft (17) upright and install tool D4.
* Adjust the height with the adjustment
bolt, put the top surface of tool D4 in
light contact with seals (19) and (221, and
set so that the clearance is uniform.
* Set tool D4 securely so that it does not 18
D4
come off.
30402
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY AXLE HOUSING
e-
a
4. Adjusting end play
1) Stand axle shaft and housing assembly (4)
upright and secure flange portion a.
30-103
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY AXLE HOUSING
30-104
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY AXLE HOUSING
5. Planetarv carrier
1) Assemble spacer (32) inside planetary car-
rier (25). 25
* Assemble the spacer from the brake
housing side.
2) Assemble bearing cone (29) to gear (28), lift
up spacer (321, and set gear (28) in position.
29 D!_WO1636
3) Align shaft (27) and spring pin hole (33), and
press fit shaft.
& Shaft : Oil (axle oil)
27
27
DLwJ163
6. Ring gear
Press fit ring gear (15) to axle housing (16), then
insert pins (34).
16 34
DLwo1639
30-106
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY AXLE HOUSING
* Reference value
. Starting turning force X:
20.6 - 59.8 N (2.1 - 6.1 kg)
3) Install stand of dial gauge to axle housing
(41, and measure end play of planetary car-
rier at end face of planetary carrier.
* Reference value
. End play of planetary carrier :
0 - 0.1 mm
DLWO1645
i
I I
(Rear)
1) Assemble outer ring (IO) to axle housing (4).
* Align outer ring pin hole and pin when
assembling.
* Be careful not to damage the front face
of the brake outer ring.
* Check that the outer ring contacts the
ring gear.
2) Assemble shaft (9).
30-108
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY AXLE HOUSING
30-I 09
a
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY AXLE HOUSING
level)
30-110
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY CENTER HINGE PIN
I
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY CENTER HINGE PIN
4. Electric wiring
I) Disconnect wiring connectors (7) and (8) for
front frame. 113
2) Disconnect clamp of wiring (9).
5. Brackets
1) Remove front center hose bracket (IO) from
front frame upper hinge.
2) Remove rear center hose bracket (I I) from
rear frame upper hinge.
6. Brake hose
Disconnect brake hose (12) from tube.
7. Steering hoses
1) Disconnect steering center hoses (13) and
(14) from rear tube. m
30-I 12
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY CENTER HINGE PIN
8. Supporting frame
1) Adjust height of rear frame and set block @
in position.
2) Set support @ under counterweight.
Ir Make sure that the left and right rear
tires cannot turn.
3) Adjust height of front frame on left and right,
then set block 0, steel sheet, and steel roll-
ers in position.
213
--CP 0-w
24
- $0 22
z?L
8aaaaa
DBwo1667
30-113
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY CENTER HINGE PIN
28
28 29
I I I L”A 1
m1672
30-114
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY CENTER HINGE PIN
d30
4) Using tools El and E2, remove bearing (32)
and spacer (33). 118
- El D8wul673
Front frame
32-
‘f
8
DBW01574
G
3
13. Upper hinge
I) Remove dust seal (34) from front frame.
37
38
DLwD1678
L
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY CENTER HINGE PIN
INSTALLATION OF CENTER
HINGE PIN
m
* Align the pilot portion securely, set the cou-
pling facing in the correct direction, and in-
stall.
* After connecting the drive shaft, remove the
block.
B Mounting bolt :
68.6 f 4.9 Nm (7.0 + 0.5 kgm)
30-116
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY CENTER HINGE PIN
m
Lower hinge pin
Insert lower hinge pin (231, and assemble
spacer (24).
6 Outside circumference of hinge pin :
Grease (G2-LI)
25
\
Upper hinge pin
Insert upper hinge pin (25) and secure with lock
bolt.
& Outside circumference of hinge pin :
Grease (G2-LII
m
Joining frame
Move front frame towards rear frame and align
pin holes.
g When aligning the position of the pin hole,
use a bar. Never insert your fingers in the
pin hole.
J, Align the pin holes exactly.
f Install the safety bar.
30-117
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY CENTER HINGE PIN
m
Lower hinge
I) Use tools E4 and E5 to press fit bearing (32)
and spacer (33) to front frame.
The clearance of bearing (32) is adjusted,
so do not change the combination with
spacer (33).
If either part must be replaced, replace E4
DBrvu1672
Upper hinge
1) Use tools E6 and E7 to press fit bearing (37)
and spacer (38) to front frame. i 1 ~eauallvaround
30418
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY CENTER HINGE PIN
I DBW1681
DBW01675
30-119
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY PRIORITY VALVE
1. Hydraulic pipins
1) Disconnect hose (2) between steering valve
and priority steering valve.
.. .
2) Disconnect hose (3) between hydraulic tank
tube and priority steering valve.
INSTALLATION OF PRIORITY
VALVE ASSEMBLY
. Carry out installation in the reverse order to
removal.
m
w Hose joint: 177 5 29 Nm (18.0 + 3.0 kgm)
(width across flats: 36 mm)
30421
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY STEERING VALVE
REMOVAL OF STEERING
VALVE ASSEMBLY
AStop the machine on level ground and install
the safety bar on the frame. Lower the bucket
J
to the ground and stop the engine. Then apply
the parking brake and put blocks under the
wheels to prevent the machine from moving.
5. Piping
Disconnect the following piping from steering
valve.
1) Disconnect hose (7) between steering valve
and priority valve.
2) Disconnect hose (8) between steering valve
and priority valve tube, then remove nipple
(9).
3) Disconnect hose (10) between steering valve
and hydraulic tank tube.
30-122
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY STEERING VALVE
6. Steering valve
Remove bracket (15) mounting bolts, then re-
move together with steering valve (16). m
INSTALLATION OF STEERING
VALVE ASSEMBLY
l Carry out installation in the reverse order to
removal.
a
m Column connecting bolt:
E 55.9 f 7.8 Nm (5.7 + 0.8 kgm)
r
5
m
QEI Steering valve bolt:
52 & 6.8 Nm (5.3 + 0.7 kgm)
m Bracket bolt:
88.3 + 34.3 Nm (9.0 +_3.5 kgm)
* Align the spline at the steering column end
and the spline at the steering valve end.
30-123
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY STEERING VALVE
DISASSEMBLY OF STEERING
VALVE
DISASSEMBLY OF ROTOR
c4_wo1702
30-124
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY STEERING VALVE
:
2
2
30425
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY STEERING VALVE
16. Pull out pin (18) from spool and sleeve assem-
bly (17).
. MWO1708
I
20
18. Turn spool (20) slowly and pull out from rear of
sleeve (19) (in the direction of the arrow).
c4_w1709
(28).
30-126
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY STEERING VALVE
ASSEMBLY OF STEERING
VALVE
Check all parts for damage or burrs.
Wash all metal parts in clean solvent and blow
dry with air.
Do not use a file or polish any part with rough
sandpaper.
Coat the O-rings with clean grease. (No need to
put grease on new X-ring seals)
Coat the O-ring for the rotor set with a small
amount of grease.
DLW01712 1
30-127
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY STEERING VALVE
I oLwo1713
10. Fit 2 bearing races (15) and thrust needle (16) in 16------ GD
$&,
h -15
15
case (10).
W
22-
CLJ
10
RWX716
30-128
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY STEERING VALVE
CUhQ1718
ASSEMBLY OF ROTOR
30-I 29
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY STEERING VALVE
I DLW01721 1’
5
DLW01722
22. Set end cap (2) on rotor set, and align bolt hole.
RwO1724
30-130
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY STEERING VALVE
30-131
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY STEERING CYLINDER
REMOVAL OF STEERING
CYLINDER ASSEMBLY
AStop the machine on level ground and install
the safety bar on the frame. Lower the bucket
to the ground and stop the engine._ Then apply
the parking brake and put blocks under the
wheels to prevent the machine from moving.
Hydraulic piping
I) Disconnect hoses (1) and (2) from cylinder.
m
Steering cylinder
I) Remove rod bolt, and pull out pin (3). m
Sr Note the number and thickness of the
shims, and use as a guideline when as-
sembling.
2) Remove bottom
bolt, and pull out pin (4).
m
3) Remove steering cylinder (5).
* Carry out the cylinder removal opera-
tion with two workers.
* Be careful not to damage the cylinder
rod.
&I
kg Steering cylinder: 20 kg
30-132
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY STEERING CYLINDER
INSTALLATION OF STEERING
CYLINDER ASSEMBLY
. Greasing
Grease each cylinder pin well.
* Wipe off any grease that is squeezed out.
30-I 33
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY RIGHT BRAKE VALVE
DISASSEMBLY OF RIGHT
BRAKE VALVE ASSEMBLY
(TANDEM)
1. Bracket assembly
1) Remove seat (I I, pedal stopper (21, and boot
(3) from brake va!ve.
2) Remove mounting bolts (5) of bracket as-
sembly (41, then remove bracket assembly.
3) Remove oil seal (6) from upper portion of
brake valve.
2. Valve
1) Install valve to jig @ with bolts (51, and se-
cure jig in vice.
* Make match marks before disassembling
the valve.
2) Remove valve mounting bolts (101, then re-
move S cylinder assembly (7).
DNvo1093 DOW01094
30-I 34
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY RIGHT BRAKE VALVE
1. Valve
install T flange assembly (9) to jig Q) with bolts
(51, and hold jig 0 in vice.
1) Install spr&s(l9), (181, and (17) to T flange
assembly (9) in order, then install holder (16)
on top of spring.
2) Install O-ring (20) to T flange assembly (9).
* Use a new part for the O-ring.
& O-ring: Lithium grease
3) Set P cylinder assembly (8) to T flange as- L
DDWOlG96
sembly (9).
* When setting in position, align the match
marks.
4) Install spring (11) and spring (15) inside
plunger of P cylinder assembly to P cylinder
assembly (8).
5) Install O-ring (12) to P cylinder assembly (8).
* Use a new part for the O-ring.
& O-ring: Lithium grease
6) Set S cylinder assembly (7) to P cylinder
assembly (81, and tighten with mounting
bolts (IO).
* When setting the S cylinder assembly in
position, align the. match marks. DEW01093 DDWO1094
B Mounting bolt:
58.8 - 73.6 Nm (6.0 - 7.5 kgm)
7) Install spring (14) and O-ring to S cylinder
assembly (71, and tighten with plug (13).
+ Use a new part for the O-ring.
& Thread of plug: Thread tightener
(Thread lock 1303B)
w Plug:
152.0 f 24.5 Nm (15.5 k 2.5 kgm)
2. Bracket assembly
Remove valve from jig 0.
1) Set T flange assembly facing up, and install
oil seal (6).
* Use a new part for the oil seal.
& Lip of oil seal: Lithium grease
2) Install bracket assembly (41, and tighten with
mounting bolts (5).
w Mounting bolt:
58.8 - 73.6 Nm (6.0 - 7.5 kgm1
3) Install seat (11, pedal stopper (21, and boot
(3) to valve.
30-I 35
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY LEFT BRAKE VALVE
1. Bracket assembly
1) Remove seat-(l), pedal stopper (2), and boot
(3) from brake valve.
2. Valve
1) Install valve to jig (TJ with bolts (5), and se-
cure jig in vice.
Ir Make match marks before disassembling
the valve.
I DEW01104 IJ DDWOllOS
30-I 36
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY LEFT BRAKE VALVE
1. Valve
Install S flange assembly (8) to jig (iJ with bolts
(51, and hold jig @ in vice.
I) Install springs (14) and (15) to S flange as-
sembly (81, then install holder (13) on top of
spring.
2) Install O-ring (16) to S flange assembly (8).
* Use a new part for the O-ring.
& O-ring: Lithium grease
2. Bracket assembly
Remove valve from jig 0.
I) Set S flange assembly facing up, and install
oil seal (6).
* Use a new part for the oil seal.
& Lip of oil seal: Lithium grease
2) Install bracket assembly (41, and tighten with
mounting bolts (5).
w Mounting bolt:
58.8 - 73.6 Nm (6.0 - 7.5 kgm)
3) Install seat (I), pedal stopper (21, and boot I
(3) to valve. I DEW01104 - DDW01105
30-I 37
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY PARKING BRAKE DISC
2. Drive shaft
Remove protector of drive shaft, and disconnect
center drive shaft (2) at transmission end. m
* After disconnecting the drive shaft, move it
to the right end.
30-I 38
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY PARKING BRAKE DISC
%--
7. Tighten tool A4 with coupling mounting bolt (4).
* Bolt length of tool : 64 mm
30-139
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY PARKING BRAKE DISC
INSTALLATION OF PARKING
BRAKE DISC
m
* Be careful to connect the coupling facing in
the correct direction.
B Mounting bolt :
68.6 + 4.9 Nm (7.0 f 0.5 kgml
m
* Be careful not to damage or get dirt on the
oil seal lip surface.
B Mounting bolt :
110.3 + 12.3 Nm (11.25 + 1.25 kgm)
& Lip of oil seal : Grease (G2-LI)
m
* Assemble the ring securely in the ring groove
of the housing.
‘Q Transmission oil : 40 J?
30-140
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY HYDRAULIC TANK
REMOVAL OF HYDRAULIC
TANK ASSEMBLY
Hydraulic piping
Disconnect the following hydraulic piping. a
. Disconnect hose (3) between PPC valve and
hydraulic tank from PPC valve end.
. Disconnect hose (4) between main control
valve and hydraulic tank from hydraulic tank
end.
. Disconnect tube (5) between brake valve and
hydraulic tank from hydraulic tank end.
. Disconnect tubes (6) and (7) between hy-
draulic, steering pump and hydraulic tank
from hydraulic tank end.
30-141
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY HYDRAULIC TANK
INSTALLATION OF HYDRAULIC
TANK ASSEMBLY
Carry out installation in the reverse order to
removal.
m
* Check that the O-ring is fitted securely in the
groove, and be careful not to get it caught.
m
* Temporarily tighten the mounting bolts, and
tighten them fully after positioning.
. (hydraulic tank)
Add oil through the oil filler to the specified
level.
* Run the engine to circulate the oil through
the system. Then check the oil level again.
30-I 42
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY HYDRAULIC FILTER
REMOVAL OF HYDRAULIC
FILTER ASSEMBLY
2. Filter
Remove spring (4) and bypass valve (51, then
remove filter (6).
INSTALLATION OF HYDRAULIC
FILTER ASSEMBLY
l Carry out installation in the reverse order to
removal.
m
* Replace the O-ring with a new part.
* Check that the O-ring is fitted securely in the
groove, and be careful not to get it caught.
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY HYDRAULIC, STEERING PUMP
REMOVAL OF HYDRAULIC,
STEERING PUMP ASSEMBLY
-
the hydraulic piping.
-4 3 I
&
ing out.
/
minal of the battery. I
-- 2 ”
l Carry out the oil return operation for the air
- -
conditioner compressor (set the fan switch to Y-
Y \
the maximum position, run the engine at low
_’ \
idling, and operate the air conditioner for 5 min- \
/ 5
utes). Then use a gauge manifold and release
.. the refrigerant slowly from the valve of the com- D&VU1746 cswo1747
pressor.
1. Hydraulic tank
Remove hydraulic tank.
For details, see REMOVAL OF HYDRAULIC TANK
ASSEMBLY.
2. Cover
1) Remove covers (2) and (3) from hood.
30-I 44
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY HYDRAULIC, STEERING PUMP
3. Ladder
Sling handrail, and lift off ladder and fender
assembly (11).
* It is difficult to maintain the balance, so be
careful of the center of gravity when lifting
off.
4. Electric wiring
Disconnect the following electric wiring from
connector.
. Electric wiring fer rear frame
LRl (121, LR3 (131, LR5 (14)
LR2 (16), LR4 (171, LR6 (18)
. Electric wiring for transmission
TL-1 (15), TL-2 (19).
20
D&V01754
30-146
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY HYDRAULIC, STEERING PUMP
30-I 47
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY HYDRAULIC, STEERING PUMP
DBwo1761
I Mviu17s?
30-148
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY HYDRAULIC. STEERING PUMP
30-I49
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY HYDRAULIC, STEERING PUMP
INSTALLATION OF
HYDRAULIC, STEERING PUMP
ASSEMBLY
30-150
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY MAIN CONTROL VALVE
1. PPC hoses
Disconnect the following hoses from main con-
trol valve. m
. Hose (2) for dump spool between PPC valve
2 DEW01nr
(P4) and main control valve (PBI)...... (blue)
. Hose (3) for lift spool between PPC valve hose
(P2) and main control valve (PB2) . . . . (yellow)
l Hose (4) for dump spool between PPC valve
(PI) and main control valve (PA11 . .. . .. . (red)
. Hose (5) for lift spool between PPC valve (P3)
and main control valve (PA21 . .. . . .. (red/white)
5 4 mm2
2. Hydraulic hoses
Disconnect the following hydraulic piping from
main control valve. m
. Disconnect hose (6) between main control
valve and hydraulic tank.
. Disconnect hose (7) between main control
valve and priority valve (switch pump end).
. Disconnect tube (8) between main control
valve and hydraulic pump.
30-I 51
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY MAIN CONTROL VALVE
DEW01775
INSTALLATION OF MAIN
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
l Carry out installation in the reverse order to
removal.
Record the hose marking and mounting po-
sition.
Fit the O-ring securely in the groove.
30-152
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY MAIN CONTROL VALVE
DISASSEMBLY OF MAIN
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
-31
30-I 54
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY MAIN CONTROL VALVE
30-I 55
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY MAIN CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY OF MAIN
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
27-
@
O 4
26- 0
29-Q
-31
I
" 25
30-156
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY MAIN CONTROL VALVE
30-157
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY MAIN CONTROL VALVE
30458
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY 3 SPOOL VALVE
DISASSEMBLY OF 3-SPOOL
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
-25
48
?5 I
26
f$p&lIy”‘.
\ 22 11 l2
\ 51 9 10 I
ta #b 33
50 \I 3’ _/
c/
6<( \\ is@
5\ 0
4 &iY+
‘#
\ _@
w GJ
Q@
\
\ 22
\ 21
DDW01547
30460
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY 3 SPOOL VALVE
1. Remove cut-off valve (2) from valve body (1). (34)spring (35) and valve (36).
4) Remove bar (37) then remove seat (38) spring
2. Spool assembly (boom) (39) and valve (40).
1) Remove case (3), then remove retainer (4)and 5) Remove plugs (41) (42), and (43).
spring (5).
2) Hold spool (19) in position with a wrench (width
across flats: 14 mm) at position a shown in
diagram on right and loosen bolt (6)Loosen bolt
(6) with spool (19) assembled to body (1). (To
6
prevent damage to the spool)
3) Remove bolt (6), then remove washer (7)retainer
(8) spring (9), retainer (IO), collar(ll), and
retainer (12).
4) Remove case (13) then remove retainer (14),
spring (15) retainer (16) spring (17) and retainer
(18).
5) Remove spool (19) from body (1)
j, Check the correct direction for assembling
spool (19) to the body.
30-161
a
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY 3 SPOOL VALVE
ASSEMBLY OF 3 SPOOL
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
26
DOW01547
30462
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY 3 SPOOL VALVE
30463
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY 3 SPOOL VALVE
DEW01551
30-164
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY PPC VALVE
1. Covers
1) Remove covers (11, (21, and (3) under cab.
I \
2. Hydraulic piping
Disconnect the following hydraulic piping from
PPC valve.
l Hose (5) between accumulator and PPC valve
l Hose (6) between PPC valve and hydraulic
tank
l Hoses P2 (7) and P3 (8) for boom spool
l Hoses P4 (9) and Pl (10) for bucket spool
5, 6
\ / ‘S(Blue)
30-165
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY PPC VALVE
3. Linkage
Loosen locknut (11) and disconnect linkage (12)
from PPC valve. a
4. PPC valve
Remove mounting bolts, then remove PPC valve
(13) from under floor.
a
* For details of adjusting the linkage, see TEST-
ING AND ADJUSTING.
30-I 66
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY PPC VALVE
r-1
DEW01222
30-167
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY PPC VALVE
Pl Bucket TILT
11
P2 Boom RAISE
P3 Boom LOWER
14
P4 Bucket DUMP
30-168
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY BUCKET CYLINDER
REMOVAL OF BUCKET
CYLINDER ASSEMBLY
AStop the machine on level ground and install
the safety bar on the frame. Lower the bucket
to the ground and stop the engine. Then apply
the parking brake and put blocks under the
wheels to prevent the machine from moving.
1. Bucket positioner
1) Disconnect connector (1).
f Remove wiring clamp and bucket. m
‘&
2. Rod pin
Sling cylinder, and remove lock bolt, then re-
move pin (2).
* Be careful of the center of gravity when sling-
ing, and lift at two places.
3. Hydraulic piping
I) Disconnect.hose (3) at rod end from cylin-
der.
4. Bucket cylinder
1) Remove lock bolt, then remove bottom pin
(6).
* If there are shims, check the number and
thickness of the shims, and keep in a
safe place. m
30-169
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY BUCKET CYLINDER
INSTALLATION OF BUCKET
CYLINDER
l Carry out installation in the reverse order to
removal.
n
* Fit the O-ring securely in the groove.
J, Install the hoses without twisting or interfer-
ence.
_
AWhen aligning the position of the pin hole, a a
use a bar. Never insert your fingers in the
pin hole.
* Align pin hole at bottom end, assemble shim
so that total clearance a between cylinder
and frame is within specified range, then
install pin and lock with bolt.
* Clearance a : Max. 1.5 mm
DBwl17Ea
30-170
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY BOOM CYLINDER
REMOVAL OF BOOM
CYLINDER
AStop the machine on level ground and install
the safety bar on the frame. Lower the bucket
to the ground and stop the engine. Then apply
the parking brake and put blocks under the
wheels to prevent the machine from moving.
1. Rod pin
1) Sling boom cylinder (I), then remove plate
(2) of rod pin, and remove pin (3). m
* If there are shims installed, check the
number and thickness of the shims, and
keep in a safe place.
2) After removing pin, start engine and oper-
ate control lever to retract cylinder rod.
* When retracting the cylinder rod, do not
retract it fully. Stop approx. 20 mm be-
8 fore the end of the stroke.
Q)
z
3
2. Hydraulic piping
1) Disconnect rod tube (4) from connection
portion of hose (5).
2) Disconnect bottom tube (6) from connection
portion of hose (7). 1121
* After disconnecting the tubes, fit covers
to prevent dirt or water from entering
the connections and hoses.
3. Boom cylinder
1) Remove lock bolt, then remove bottom pin
(8).
* If there are shims installed, check the
number and thickness of the shims, and
keep in a safe place. B
2) Lift off boom cylinder (I).
* Be careful to maintain the balance and
lift off slowly.
* Be careful not to damage the cylinder
rod.
kg
rE?l Boom cylinder : 108 kg
30-171
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY BOOM CYLINDER
INSTALLATION OF BOOM
CYLINDER ASSEMBLY
l Carry out installation in the reverse order to
removal.
m
* Install the hoses without twisting or interfer-
ence.
l Greasing
* Grease each pin well.
30472
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY HYDRAULIC CYLINDER
DISASSEMBLY OF HYDRAULIC
CYLINDER ASSEMBLY
Steering- cylinder
(STEERING, BOOM, BUCKET CYLINDER AS-
SEMBLY)
3. Cylinder head
. Steering cylinder assembly
1) Set cylinder head and piston rod assembly
(3) to tool F.
2) Using tool H, remove nut (8).
Sr Width across flats of nut: 46 mm
3) Remove piston (91, then remove cylinder
head (2).
1 Dmm797
I DEW01251
DEW01252
1
30-174
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY HYDRAULIC CYLINDER
21 19
24
DEW01254
30-175
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY HYDRAULIC CYLINDER
ASSEMBLY OF HYDRAULIC
CYLINDER ASSEMBLY
(STEERING, BOOM, BUCKET CYLINDER AS-
SEMBLY)
26
DEW01257
18
30-176
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY HYDRAULIC CYLINDER
Q
7
2
Cylinder Nmky-n)
Boom cylinder
110.8f 12.8l11.3 +I.31
Bucket cylinder
30-I 77
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY HYDRAULIC CYLINDER
5. Cylinder head
. Boom, bucket cylinder
1) Set cylinder (7) to tool F.
2) Raise cylinder head and piston rod assem-
bly (6) and assemble to cylinder (7).
3) Install cylinder head (2) to cylinder (7).
w Mounting bolt:
Nm(kgm)
Boom cylinder 162 f 15 (16.5 ?I 1.5)
Bucket cylinder 250 L!Z25 (25.5 & 2.5)
30-178
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY WORK EQUIPMENT
REMOVAL OF WORK
EQUIPMENT ASSEMBLY
AStop the machine on level ground and install
the safety bar on the frame. Lower the bucket
to the ground and stop the engine. Then apply
the parking brake and put blocks under the
wheels to prevent the machine from moving.
1. Bucket link
I) Remove bucket link mounting pin (11. m
* Secure the bucket link to the bellcrank
with wire.
* If there are shims, check the number and
thickness of the shims, and keep in a
safe place.
rel
kg Bucket cylinder : 107 kg
3. Boom cylinder a
Sling boom cylinder (61, and remove mounting
pin (5).
* If there are shims, check the number and
thickness of the shims, and keep in a safe
place.
* Set blocks on the top of the axle and lower
the cylinder.
k’d
rE?l Boom, bellcrank, bucket link assem-
bly : 1,117 kg
* If there are shims, check the number and
thickness of the shims, and keep in a
safe place.
PI kg Bucket link : 35 kg
D&W1813
30-180
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY WORK EQUIPMENT
/
6. Dust seal, bushing
1) Pull out dust seal (14) and bushing (15) from
m
13
2)
, I
DBW02288
16
cBwa818
WV.'01816
@qr
18
18
19
30-181
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY WORK EQUIPMENT
INSTALLATION OF WORK
EQUIPMENT ASSEMBLY
l Carry out installation in the reverse order to
removal.
a
. Bucket link
1) Raise bucket link (91, align hole of mounting
pin (11, and install cord rings (21). Insert
shims so that clearance a is uniform on left
and right, then assemble mounting pin and
lock with bolt.
* Be careful not to get the cord ring caught.
* Clearance a : Max. 1.5 mm
AWhen aligning the position of the pin
hole, use a bar. Never insert your fin-
gers in the pin hole.
m
. Bucket
I) Operate control lever, align hole of bucket
mounting pin (21, and install cord rings (20).
Insert shims so that clearance b is uniform
on left and right, then assemble mounting
pin and lock with bolt.
* Be careful not to get the cord ring caught.
* Clearance b : Max. 1.5 mm
A When aligning the position of the pin
hole, use a bar. Never insert your fin-
gers in the pin hole.
If
. Bucket cylinder
a When aligning the position of the pin hole,
use a bar. Never insert your fingers in the
pin hole.
30-182
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY WORK EQUIPMENT
prJ
. Boom cylinder
ABefore starting the engine, check that the
directional lever is at,neutral and the park-
ing brake is applied.
Awhen aligning the position of the pin hole,
use a bar. Never insert your fingers in the
pin hole.
l Greasing
* Grease each pin well.
30-183
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY COUNTERWEIGHT
REMOVAL OF
COUNTERWEIGHT
AStop the machine on level ground and install
the safety bar on the frame. Lower the bucket
to the ground and stop the engine. Then apply
the parking brake and put blocks under the
wheels to prevent the machine from moving.
1. Grill
1) Remove 4 mounting bolts (2) of grill (I).
* Remove the washers, cushions, and
spacers at the same time.
2. Counterweight
1) Sling counterweight (5), then remove mount-
ing bolts and lift off.
* When removing the counterweight, be
careful to maintain the balance. m
INSTALLATION OF ’
COUNTERWEIGHT
l Carry out installation in the reverse order to
removal.
m
* Connect the wiring connectors securely.
30-I 84
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY CAB
1. Cover
1) Remove covers (‘I), (21, and (3) from under
floor.
2. Electric wiring
I) Disconnect cab wiring connectors (7). /KJ
* Fit tags to distinguish the connectors.
(Connectors CLl, CL2, CL3)
3. Hoses
I) Disconnect 2 window washer hoses (8).
Jr Make marks to distinguish the hoses.
* Drain the washer fluid.
4. Cab
I) Remove steering post and cab mounting
bolts (9).
* Pull the steering post to tip it down.
30485
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY CAB
30-I 86
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY CAB
rBRACKET
/ rFLOOR LINE
\SUPPORT
1 (8) BOLTS
2 (8) WASHERS
/
SM320CAB
1. Remove plugs from roof top and put in eye-bolts for lifting.
3. Lift cab off the floor or pallet to install seal around inner lower edge of the cab.
5. Secure electrical harness so it will not fall out during cab assembly to floor.
6. Install cab to the floor of the machine, watching and being careful not to damage front dash.
30-187
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY CAB
7. When on the floor install loose (1) 8 bolts and (2) 8 washers each side of the ROPS. and 2 bolts (01010-51240)
and 2 washers (01643-31232) loose for alignment.
A: Clearance of 5 mm ROPS support and bolt (3) when assembling adjust clearance of cab position to all around
min. 2 mm.
B: Clearance of 7 mm between ROPS support and bracket, when assembling adjust clearance of cab position to
min. 4 mm.
9. Tightening these bolts temporary and hold the ROPS blocks square to the rear ROPS ears and HOLD all
dimensions as shown in diagram. These must not come in contact.
IO. Insert mounting adjustment tool (4) through the 40 mm diameter of the ROPS support, if it will not go through, then
loosen bolts (1) of the bracket and add shims (5) until it goes through.
12. Use shims (6) in front of the cab at floor, add the number required to fill this space. Then tighten finally at 12 kgm.
13. Remove lifting device and eye-bolts and put the plugs back into the roof.
14. Plug in the rear defrost flexible hose to the air box and tighten,
15. In the front of the cab make sure vent ducts line up with the floor holes, they may need adjustment.
16. Add ether switch to the cab and plug in the wire left floor guard area.
17. Plug in the lighter on the left side of the floor guard area, connect harness.
18. From the floor area front right side, plug in washer bottle plastic tubes. In the same area, plug in 12 pin white plug
with cab harness with the cab harness plug.
19. Check function of dome light, door open lite,, front/rear wipers and washer, work lights in cab. Plug in the heater
controller and check functions.
20. When everything works properly, reinstall fiber dash covers and add the floor mat.
22. Put lower covers back around the outside of the floor.
30-188
a
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY MAIN MONITOR
30-I 90
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY MAIN MONITOR
0 0
16
DEW01309
INSTALLATION OF MAIN
MONITOR ASSEMBLY
jl
* Fit the connector lock securely.
30-I91
0
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY MAINTENANCE MONITOR
REMOVAL OF MAINTENANCE
MONITOR ASSEMBLY
AStop the machine on level ground and install
the safety bar on the frame. Lower the bucket to
the ground and stop the engine. Then apply the
parking brake and put blocks under the wheels
to prevent the machine from moving.
1. Cover
1) Remove cover (I) from cab.
* Remove the cover and leave the bolts
loosened.
2) Remove cover (2).
* Open the fuse box cover and leave the
bolts loosened.
3) Remove monitor covePf3).
* Remove pad assembly (4) and mounting
bolt cap (5).
* Remove the boot.
* Turn the cover to the outside.
2. Maintenance monitor
1) Remove mounting bolts, then remove main-
tenance monitor (6).
* Move the maintenance monitor to the
side.
INSTALLATION OF
MAINTENANCE MONITOR
ASSEMBLY
l Carry out installation in the reverse order to
removal.
a
* Connect the connectors securely.
30-192
0
40 MAINTENANCE STANDARD
40-I
MAINTENANCE STANDARD ENGINE MOUNT, TRANSMISSION MOUNT
\ 113 2 10 N-m
m
279 + 34N-m
Unit: mm
40-2
0
MAINTENANCE STANDARD TORQUE CONVERTER CHARGING PUMP
A-A
a=
113ilONm
(11.52l.Okgm)
Unit: mm
4 Rotating torque of
5.9 - 13.7Nm (0.6 - 1.4kgm)
spline shaft
Standard Delivery
Rotating Delivery deliven/ amount
Model speed pressure amount limit
Discharge amount
- Oil: EOlO-CD SAL(2140 3,OOOrpm (3~~g~cp~2~ 115P/min 106l/min
Oil temperature: 45 -
55°C
SAL12120 59//min 53Flmin
-
40-3
MAINTENANCE STANDARD TORQUE CONVERTER
TORQUE CONVERTER
w
66.227.4Nm 30.923.4Nm
(6.754.75kgm) (3.77+0.35kgm) 4
/ w
66.2-+7.4Nm
w
30.9z3.4Nm
(6>5&.75kgm)
(3.15+0.35kgm)
Unit: mm
I
No. Check item Criteria Remedy
40-4
MAINTENANCE STANDARD TRANSMISSION
TRANSMISSION
w w w
11.3k1.47Nm
34.3+4.9Nm llOe12.3Nm
(3.5dXkgm) (11.2S1.25kgm) (1.15kO.15kgm)
\ / \B---I
w
11.3+1.47Nm
(l.EtO.15kgm)
w
1lh12.3Nm
(11.2~1.25kgm)
w
66.6.W.4Nm
(6.75d.75kgm)
w
3D4+49Nm
(31z5kgm)
w
1lOel2.3Nm
(11.25F1.25kgm)
\ &&7.4Nm
cs= (6.7W.75kgm) A
66&7.4Nm
(6.75eO.75kgm)
w
w
110-+12.3Nm i
304+49Nm
(31Gkgm)
(11.25i1.25kgm) P-c
w
llh123Nm
(11.2~1.25kgm)
m
-LU kgm)
w
llOz12.3Nm
(11.2&l .25kgm)
_ m
1l(k12.3Nm
iK-
htrn,
66.2~7.4Nm
177d9Nm
, Iozxyrr,,
I.0. c)I__-\
-
_s7@
7
133.8d22.1Nm
(14.25&.25kgm)
(11.2&1.25kgm) (6.75+0.75kgm)
40-5
MAINTENANCE STANDARD
TRANSMISSION
12
-29
'25
22.243'3
25
27 110.~12.3Nm
A-A
40-6
MAINTENANCE STANDARD TRANSMISSION
B-B
m
299.1432Nm
K30.529.5kgm) ,.
E-E
D-D
40-7
MAINTENANCE STANDARD TRANSMISSION
- Unit: mm
40-8
MAINTENANCE STANDARD TRANSMISSION
Unit: mm
I I I
NO.1 Check item
I
Criteria
I Remedy
40-9
MAINTENANCE STANDARD TRANSMISSION
FORWARD/REVERSE Clutch
12 14 9 8 7 13 11
t
6
SAmm
Unit: mm
Clearance at forward/
reverse clutch shaft +0.034 -0.020 -0.041 -
6 bearing end spacer press- 50 +0.021 -0.040 -0.074 -
- fitted section
Standard size 1 Tolerance Repair limit
Separator plate thickness
I.7 kO.05 I.6
7 I I
40-10
MAINTENANCE STANDARD TRANSMISSION
Unit: mm
Thickness of forward/
10 reverse clutch thrust 3.0 +0.1 2.7
washer
40-11
MAINTENANCE STANDARD TRANSMISSION
8 1 1 9 7
6
7-T-7+\ 6 6 5
\ 3
SAW00759
Unit: mm
40-12
MAINTENANCE STANDARD TRANSMISSION
2nd and 4th Clutch
Unit: mm
40-13
MAINTENANCE STANDARD TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
w
30.9*3.4Nm
(3.15tO.35kgm) A4 w
66.&7.4Nm
(6.754.75kgm)
39.&4.9Nm
(4.0+0.5kgm)
\
2,
/
13 A-A
40-14
MAINTENANCE STANDARD TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
No Check item
I
Criteria
I Remedy
I 74.2
I
49
463+23N
(47.2+2.4kg) I
71.2
417N
(42.5kg) I
0.98&0.05N 0.88N
9 Quick return valve spring 40 30.5 (O.l+O.O05kg) 38.4 (0.09kg)
40-15
MAINTENANCE STANDARD TRANSMISSl.ON CONTROL VALVE
LOWER VALVE
w w
12.5t4.66Nm
w
30.9+3.4Nm
1.62+0.15Nm
(O.l65+015kgrn) U’m.475kgm) (3.15+0.35kgm)
w 30.9S3.4Nm
1.62-9.15Nm
(0.165d.015kgm) (3.15&.35kgm)
w
30.9+3.4Nm
(3.15&35kgm)
B-B
40-16
MAINTENANCE STANDARD TRANSMISSION CONTROL VALVE
Unit: mm
Criteria
MAINTENANCE STANDARD MODULATION VALVE ASSEMBLY
3 8
9 4 2 6 7 1
A-A SAm
Unit: mm
I
No, Check item Criteria Remedy
8 Accumulator spring
40-18
MAINTENANCE STANDARD ACCUMULATOR VALVE
ACCUMULATOR VALVE
A-A
Y,
P I 4
53L9.6Nm
fZLt2Okgm)~
Unit: mm
Standard
size
, Clearance between piston
and body
-0.035 +0.025 0.035 -
32 I -0.045 0 0.070 0.08
2 Forward clutch accumula- f%ee length lnstalfsdlengthInstalled load Free length Installed loac Replace
tor spring
184.8
I 175
158N
f16.lkg) 177.4 -
40-I9
MAINTENANCE STANDARD DRIVE SHAFT
DRIVE SHAFT
(3/8 IN 1
89 + 5 N.m
279 + 29 N-m
. . ..a \
/
\NlIUt
(3/8 IN)
54 c 3 Nom
VW
Front Drlvo Shaft 279 2 29 N.m
(Ml6 )
69 + 5 N-m
(MlO)
\
40-20
0
MAINTENANCE STANDARD DIFFERENTIAL
DIFFERENTIAL (l/2)
w1lh12Nm 52=
llOtl2Nm
w110L12Nm
(11&125kgmj 1, (11.25zlZkgm) (11~125kgml
\ /
177LZONm 277Gi2Nm
m
(189kgm)
..
(28.25+325kgm)
4.421.5Nm wllQ+12Nm
(0.4&0.15kgm)
(ll.Sl25kgm)
I
w’
108215Nm
’
m
177SONm
m
2716&14Nm
(11.0+1.5kgm) (18&kgm) (15.5i2.5kgm) P7M2kgm)
Unit: mm
40-21
MAINTENANCE STANDARD DIFFERENTIAL
DIFFERENTIAL (2/2)
40-22
MAINTENANCE STANDARD DIFFERENTIAL
Unit: mm
Clearance at
1 differential side Outer lace
bearing
+0.051 -0.066 -
inner lace 75 +0.032 1.015 -0.032 -
-0.048 -0.088 -
Clearance at Outer lace 140 4.18 -0.088 -0.030 -
2 pinion shaft
gear side +0.039 -0.054 -
bearing Inner lace, 65 +0.020 4.015 -0.020 -
-0.041 -0.076 -
Clearance at Outer lace 120 Jo15 -0.076 -0.026 -
pinion shaft
coupling side
+0.039 a.054 -
bearing Inner lace 55 Replace
I +0.020 I 1.015 -0.020 -
Adjust
Differential gear backlash 0.10 - 0.25
40-23
MAINTENANCE STANDARD FINAL DRIVE
FINAL DRIVE
F z!9Nnl
6 (94.5+10.5kgm)
\ /’ I
.. 8
40-24
MAINTENANCE STANDARD FINAL DRIVE
Unit: mm
..
+0.21
160 - - -
Axle shaft seal Hous’ng +O.ll
5 press-fitted
section
Shaft 126 - -
l.063 -
-
Clearance between pinion +0.025 +0.013 -0.025 -
6 gear bearing and shaft 33.338 +0.013 0 0 -
40-25
MAINTENANCE STANDARD AXLE MOUNT
AXLE MOUNT
w 927&9Nm
/ (94.5+10kgm)
A-A
sEwa
Unit: mm
+0.3 -
Thickness of wear plate 5
-0.1
Tolerance Replace
Standard Standard Clearance
Clearance between hole size Shaft Hole clearance limit
3 and shaft at front support
end -0.050 +0.472 0.050 -
190
-0.122 0 0.594 -
-
Clearance between hole +0.522
-0.005 0.055 -
4 and shaft at rear support 170
-0.124 +0.050 0.646 -
end
40-26
MAINTENANCE STANDARD CENTER HINGE PIN
w 112.8t9.8Nm
(11.5+1.0kgm)
/
,13
‘17
w 112.829.8Nm 14 13
(11.5+1.0kgm)
A-A B-B
sBwoJ767
40-28
MAINTENANCE STANDARD CENTER HINGE PIN
Unit: mm
40-29
MAINTENANCE STANDARD STEERING COLUMN
STEERING COLUMN
w 29.4+2.9Nm
n
(3.04.3kgm)
Unit: mm
Clearance between
1 steering shaft and column Replace
bearing
40-30
MAINTENANCE STANDARD PRIORITY VALVE
PRIORITY VALVE
FOR STEERING PUMP CIRCUIT
Unit: mm
274N 274f19.6N
62 47.6 62fl (27.9f2kg)
(27.9kg)
40-3 1
MAINTENANCE STANDARD STEERING CYLINDER MOUNT
Unit: mm
Clearance between
mounting pin and bushing +0.150 0.175 -
2 at connection of steering 40 -EL025 +0.050 0.050 -
Replace
cylinder bottom and frame
Standard clearance
Width of boss Width of hinge
(clearance a + b)
Connection between
3 steering cylinder and Max. 0.5
50+0.8 - (after adjusting
front frame 0 with shim)
Connection between Max. 0.5
4 steering cylinder and 50 54f0.8 (after adjusting
rear frame with shim)
40-32
MAINTENANCE STANDARD BRAKE
BRAKE
Unit: mm
I I
No. Check item Criteria Remedy
40-33
MAINTENANCE STANDARD BRAKE VALVE
BRAKE VALVE
BRAKE VALVE (LEFT)
w 66.h7.3Nm
(6.75tO.75kgm)I f
7.8iZNm
(0.&0.2kgm)
w 152&4.5Nm y
(15.592.5kgm)
Unit: mm
No Check item
6 C$?darpainnce
between roller 10 -0.025
-0.075 +O.l
0 0.175
0.025
- 29.2
40-35
MAINTENANCE STANDARD BRAKE VALVE
w 66A73Nm
(6.75F0.75kgm)
7.8dNm
(0.8+0.2kgm)
66.&7.3Nm
(6.7W.75kgm)
m 15294.5Nm /
(15.5cZkgm)
40-36
MAINTENANCE STANDARD BRAKE VALVE
Unit: mm
l-
No Check item Criteria Remedy
C
459N
2 Control spring 46.3 34.3 (46.8kg)
60.8N
3 Return spring 86.2 58 (6.2kg3
69.6N
Spring 17 15 Replace
(7.1 kg)
16.7N -
Return spring 31.5 19.5 28
(1.7kg)
Standard Clearance
clearance limit
0.175 -
0.025 0.25
+
7
C$yce between roller
10
Standard
-0.025
-0.075
size
+o. 1
0
Tolerance
“‘:“,,
8 Outside diameter of roller
30 4.5
29.2
1
40-37
MAINTENANCE STANDARD PARKING BRAKE
PARKING
5 4 6
sAwooTI4
Unit: mm
I
Zlearance o-
+0.13
1 ,etween piston Inner side 215 0.18 0.23
4.05 0
and cylinder
-
Outer sideI 250 -0.10
-0.15 +0.13
0 I 0.10 0.28 0.33
I I
1,125*56N 1,012N
3 Parking brake spring 76.5 52.0 (114.7f5.7kg) 68.9 (103.2kg3
Depth of
+0.175
5 Brake disc lining 0.45 0.375
0
groove
Lining -
thickness 0.7 kO.075
40-38
MAINTENANCE STANDARD HYDRAULIC PUMP
w
279e29Nm
w
279&!9Nm
w
113+9.8Nm
279e29Nm
(28.5dkgm) (28.5+3kgm) CB.5dkgm) (ll.%lkgm)
!swlo672
Unit: mm
l-
No. Check it&m Criteria Remedy
1 Side clearance
lt+%&J 0.10 - 0.15 0.19
-
Rotating torque of spline
4 22.6 - 40.2Nm (2.3 - 4.lkgm)
shaft
-
Rotating Delivery Standard deli- Delivery
Model pressure very amount amount limi t
speed
Discharge amount SAL(3)71 1581/min 146Vmin
- 20.6Mpa2 -
Oil: EOlO-CD
oil temperature: 45 - 55°C SAL(3132 2 500rpm (210kg/cm ) 73Clmin 681/min
2.9Mpa
SAL(l)20 681/min 631/min
(30kg/cmz)
- i
40-39
MAINTENANCE STANDARD MAIN CONTROL VALVE
w w
69+10Nm 226elONm
(7+lkgm) C&l kgm)
E
w
- 30.9di.4Nm
(3.15eO.35kgm) w
152&?5Nm
(15.59.5kgm)
w
22&10Nm
(23elkgm)
w m
31dNm
l! 52&5Nm (3.15eO.35kgm)
-- --.
(15.54.5lcgm)
El /
w
4tS25Nm
(47.5&.5kgm)
6
40-40
MAINTENANCE STANDARD MAIN CONTROL VALVE
Unit: mm
40-41
MAINTENANCE STANDARD MAIN CONTROL VALVE
3-SPOOL VALVE
m
13.3%1.5Nm
(1.354.15kgm)
226elONm
4 /
(2321 kgm)
Y ii2+25Nm
(15.5&.5kgm)
w
w 152225Nm
11+3Nm (15.5&.5kgm)
__- _^_. ._
(3.1520 m.;uKgrn,
/
22elONm 7
(2321 kgm)
w
226+lONm
GSlkgm)
/ 6
w
4E&25Nm
w (47.5e2.5kgm)
8
275dONm
40-42
MAINTENANCE STANDARD MAIN CONTROL VALVE
Unit: mm
E$&
1 Spool return spring
g;nbjucket and attach-
54.8 53.5
-
Spool return spring
2 54.8 52.2
(for bucket and boom)
-
3
Spool return spring
(for bucket and boom) 30.7 26.8 y&g ! - / -
Spool return spring 233N -
4 55.3 40 (23.8kg) -
(for boom) I
-I- Replace
Spool return spring 208N -
5 86.8 83.5 (21.2kg) -
(for boom)
zq -
-
E
Main relief valve main
valve spring 39.5 23.2 ! -
259N 208N
7 Relief valve poppet spring 49.3 41.9 (26.4kg) 47.8 (21.2kg)
-
E
E
Check valve spring
27.9
24.5
19
)
40-43
MAINTENANCE STANDARD PPC VALVE
WC VALVE
Unit: mm
16.7 N 13.7 N
3 Metering spring 31.4 x 7.4 29.4
(1.7 kg) - (1.4 kg)
40-44
MAINTENANCE STANDARD HYDRAULIC CYLINDER
HYDRAULIC CYLINDER
/--- _’
Unit: mm
I I I
Check item Criteria
I Remedy
-
Clearance be- Boom 75 -0.030
-0.104 +0.291 0.107 0.695
+0.077 0.395
1 tween piston rod Replace
and bushing -0.030 +0.271 0.091 -
Bucket 80 -0.104 +0.061 0.675
0.375
I I I I I
I
I
I I
-
Steering 40 -0.025 +0.132 0.031
0.219 0.519
-0.087 +0.006
40-45
MAINTENANCE STANDARD WORK EQUIPMENT LINKAGE
11
B-B
b
c-c b
36
a b a’ b a’ b
D-D E-E F-F
a b a b b
G-G H-H J-J
SAW0777
40-46
MAINTENANCE STANDARD WORK EQUIPMENT LINKAGE
- 7
Unit: mm
bucket link
1.0
-
Clearance between pin
2 and bushing at connection 1.0
- of boom and bucket
Clearance between pin
3 and bushing at connection 1.0
- of boom and frame
Clearance between pin
and bushing at connection Replace
4 1.0
of bucket cylinder bottom
and frame ~&fre$?
-
Clearance between pin pin
and bushing at connection
5 1.0
of bucket cylinder rod and
bellcrank
-
Clearance between pin
6 and bushing at connection 1.0
of bellcrank and boom
-
Clearance between pin
and bushing at connection +0.227 0.077 - 1.0
7 of boom cylinder bottom -0.076 +0.047 0.303
and frame
-
Clearance between pin
and bushing at connection -0.030 +0.174 0.130 -
8 1.0
of boom cylinder rod and -0.076 +O.lOO 0.250
boom
- ,_ .
Standard I clearance
Width of boss (Clearance a + b)
Connection of bucket
9 cylinder and frame
9o*s 0.7 - 4.5
- Replace
10
Connection of boom and 1011tl.l 1.9 - 5.6 insert Aims on
frame bothsidesso
- that clearance
;;meytion of boom and 105fl.l 108+k5 1.9 - 5.6 is lessthan 15
11 mmonboth
- IelI and right
Connection of bucket link
12 104$j 109+;5 2.2 - 6.0
and bucket
-
Connection of boom
13 cylinder and frame 85+t8 89f1.5 1.7 - 5.5
II
-
Connection of bellcrank
14 and bucket link 1042:; 109k1.5 0.7 - 7.0
-
Connection of bellcrank 2.0 - 4.0 Replace
15 25OkO.5 253kO.5
and boom
-
-
16
Connection of bucket
cylinder and bellcrank
go+0.8
0 I 93t1.5
I
0.7 - 4.5
40-47
MAINTENANCE STANDARD BUCKET
BUCKET
tie
km
-108Nm
(lOl=llkgm)
/
A-A
m
863+49Nm
(88Akgm) .
B-B
A-A c-c
I I
Check
I
I
40-48
MAINTENANCE STANDARD BUCKET POSITIONER AND BOOM KICK-OUT
I /
-=I=4
.
2
..
!
::::-7ri::
i.
..
\
G=J
53.9il9.6Nm
(5.54cgm)
w
17.7&ONm
WXtO2kgm)
A-A
Unit: mm
I I I
NoI Check item Criteria
I
Remedy
40-49
Komatsu America international Company
440 North Fairwav Drive I 1
Vernon Hills, IL 66061-8112 U.S.A.
Attn: Technical Publications 1 PROPOSAL FOR MANUAL REVlslON 1
Fax No. (847) 970-4186 I I
’ NAME OF COMPANY:
;
3
DEPARTMENT: 1 DATE:
WANUAL NAME:
MANUAL NO:
MACHINE MODEL:
3/N IF APPLICABLE:
‘AGE NO:
‘ROBLEM:
PFMRl 08169